Fix Aarch64 bug in warning filtering.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf.c
1 /* ELF executable support for BFD.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1993-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23 /*
24 SECTION
25 ELF backends
26
27 BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
28 Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
29 (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
30
31 Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
32 to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
33 haven't bothered yet. */
34
35 /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
36 #define _SYSCALL32
37 #include "sysdep.h"
38 #include "bfd.h"
39 #include "bfdlink.h"
40 #include "libbfd.h"
41 #define ARCH_SIZE 0
42 #include "elf-bfd.h"
43 #include "libiberty.h"
44 #include "safe-ctype.h"
45 #include "elf-linux-core.h"
46
47 #ifdef CORE_HEADER
48 #include CORE_HEADER
49 #endif
50
51 static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
52 static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
53 static bfd_boolean prep_headers (bfd *);
54 static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct elf_strtab_hash **, int) ;
55 static bfd_boolean elf_read_notes (bfd *, file_ptr, bfd_size_type,
56 size_t align) ;
57 static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
58 file_ptr offset, size_t align);
59
60 /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
61 currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
62 need to move into elfcode.h. */
63
64 /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
65
66 void
67 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
68 const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
69 Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
70 {
71 dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
72 dst->vd_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
73 dst->vd_ndx = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
74 dst->vd_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
75 dst->vd_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
76 dst->vd_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
77 dst->vd_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
78 }
79
80 /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
81
82 void
83 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
84 const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
85 Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
86 {
87 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
88 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
89 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
90 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
91 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
92 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
93 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
94 }
95
96 /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
97
98 void
99 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
100 const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
101 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
102 {
103 dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
104 dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
105 }
106
107 /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
108
109 void
110 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
111 const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
112 Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
113 {
114 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
115 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
116 }
117
118 /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
119
120 void
121 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
122 const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
123 Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
124 {
125 dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
126 dst->vn_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
127 dst->vn_file = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
128 dst->vn_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
129 dst->vn_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
130 }
131
132 /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
133
134 void
135 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
136 const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
137 Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
138 {
139 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
140 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
141 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
142 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
143 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
144 }
145
146 /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
147
148 void
149 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
150 const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
151 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
152 {
153 dst->vna_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
154 dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
155 dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
156 dst->vna_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
157 dst->vna_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
158 }
159
160 /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
161
162 void
163 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
164 const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
165 Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
166 {
167 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
168 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
169 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
170 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
171 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
172 }
173
174 /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
175
176 void
177 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
178 const Elf_External_Versym *src,
179 Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
180 {
181 dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
182 }
183
184 /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
185
186 void
187 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
188 const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
189 Elf_External_Versym *dst)
190 {
191 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
192 }
193
194 /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
195 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
196
197 unsigned long
198 bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
199 {
200 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
201 unsigned long h = 0;
202 unsigned long g;
203 int ch;
204
205 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
206 {
207 h = (h << 4) + ch;
208 if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
209 {
210 h ^= g >> 24;
211 /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
212 this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
213 h ^= g;
214 }
215 }
216 return h & 0xffffffff;
217 }
218
219 /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
220 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
221
222 unsigned long
223 bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
224 {
225 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
226 unsigned long h = 5381;
227 unsigned char ch;
228
229 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
230 h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
231 return h & 0xffffffff;
232 }
233
234 /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
235 the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
236 bfd_boolean
237 bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
238 size_t object_size,
239 enum elf_target_id object_id)
240 {
241 BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
242 abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
243 if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
244 return FALSE;
245
246 elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
247 if (abfd->direction != read_direction)
248 {
249 struct output_elf_obj_tdata *o = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof *o);
250 if (o == NULL)
251 return FALSE;
252 elf_tdata (abfd)->o = o;
253 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
254 }
255 return TRUE;
256 }
257
258
259 bfd_boolean
260 bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
261 {
262 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
263 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
264 bed->target_id);
265 }
266
267 bfd_boolean
268 bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
269 {
270 /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
271 if (!abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd))
272 return FALSE;
273 elf_tdata (abfd)->core = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd)->core));
274 return elf_tdata (abfd)->core != NULL;
275 }
276
277 static char *
278 bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
279 {
280 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
281 bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
282 file_ptr offset;
283 bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
284
285 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
286 if (i_shdrp == 0
287 || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
288 || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
289 return NULL;
290
291 shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
292 if (shstrtab == NULL)
293 {
294 /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
295 offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
296 shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
297
298 /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
299 in case the string table is not terminated. */
300 if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
301 || shstrtabsize > bfd_get_file_size (abfd)
302 || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
303 || (shstrtab = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1)) == NULL)
304 shstrtab = NULL;
305 else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab, shstrtabsize, abfd) != shstrtabsize)
306 {
307 if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call)
308 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
309 bfd_release (abfd, shstrtab);
310 shstrtab = NULL;
311 /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
312 trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
313 the string table over and over. */
314 i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
315 }
316 else
317 shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
318 i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
319 }
320 return (char *) shstrtab;
321 }
322
323 char *
324 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
325 unsigned int shindex,
326 unsigned int strindex)
327 {
328 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
329
330 if (strindex == 0)
331 return "";
332
333 if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
334 return NULL;
335
336 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
337
338 if (hdr->contents == NULL)
339 {
340 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB && hdr->sh_type < SHT_LOOS)
341 {
342 /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89. */
343 /* xgettext:c-format */
344 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: attempt to load strings from"
345 " a non-string section (number %d)"),
346 abfd, shindex);
347 return NULL;
348 }
349
350 if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
351 return NULL;
352 }
353
354 if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
355 {
356 unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
357 _bfd_error_handler
358 /* xgettext:c-format */
359 (_("%pB: invalid string offset %u >= %" PRIu64 " for section `%s'"),
360 abfd, strindex, (uint64_t) hdr->sh_size,
361 (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
362 ? ".shstrtab"
363 : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
364 return NULL;
365 }
366
367 return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
368 }
369
370 /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
371 SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
372 symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
373 are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
374 symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
375 Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
376 or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
377
378 Elf_Internal_Sym *
379 bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
380 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
381 size_t symcount,
382 size_t symoffset,
383 Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
384 void *extsym_buf,
385 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
386 {
387 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
388 void *alloc_ext;
389 const bfd_byte *esym;
390 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
391 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
392 Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
393 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
394 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
395 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
396 size_t extsym_size;
397 bfd_size_type amt;
398 file_ptr pos;
399
400 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
401 abort ();
402
403 if (symcount == 0)
404 return intsym_buf;
405
406 /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
407 shndx_hdr = NULL;
408 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd) != NULL)
409 {
410 elf_section_list * entry;
411 Elf_Internal_Shdr **sections = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
412
413 /* Find an index section that is linked to this symtab section. */
414 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
415 {
416 /* PR 20063. */
417 if (entry->hdr.sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
418 continue;
419
420 if (sections[entry->hdr.sh_link] == symtab_hdr)
421 {
422 shndx_hdr = & entry->hdr;
423 break;
424 };
425 }
426
427 if (shndx_hdr == NULL)
428 {
429 if (symtab_hdr == & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd))
430 /* Not really accurate, but this was how the old code used to work. */
431 shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)->hdr;
432 /* Otherwise we do nothing. The assumption is that
433 the index table will not be needed. */
434 }
435 }
436
437 /* Read the symbols. */
438 alloc_ext = NULL;
439 alloc_extshndx = NULL;
440 alloc_intsym = NULL;
441 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
442 extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
443 amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * extsym_size;
444 pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
445 if (extsym_buf == NULL)
446 {
447 alloc_ext = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, extsym_size);
448 extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
449 }
450 if (extsym_buf == NULL
451 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
452 || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
453 {
454 intsym_buf = NULL;
455 goto out;
456 }
457
458 if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
459 extshndx_buf = NULL;
460 else
461 {
462 amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
463 pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
464 if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
465 {
466 alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *)
467 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
468 extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
469 }
470 if (extshndx_buf == NULL
471 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
472 || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
473 {
474 intsym_buf = NULL;
475 goto out;
476 }
477 }
478
479 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
480 {
481 alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *)
482 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym));
483 intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
484 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
485 goto out;
486 }
487
488 /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
489 isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
490 for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
491 shndx = extshndx_buf;
492 isym < isymend;
493 esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
494 if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
495 {
496 symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
497 /* xgettext:c-format */
498 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB symbol number %lu references"
499 " nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
500 ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
501 if (alloc_intsym != NULL)
502 free (alloc_intsym);
503 intsym_buf = NULL;
504 goto out;
505 }
506
507 out:
508 if (alloc_ext != NULL)
509 free (alloc_ext);
510 if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
511 free (alloc_extshndx);
512
513 return intsym_buf;
514 }
515
516 /* Look up a symbol name. */
517 const char *
518 bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
519 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
520 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
521 asection *sym_sec)
522 {
523 const char *name;
524 unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
525 unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
526
527 if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
528 /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
529 && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
530 {
531 iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
532 shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
533 }
534
535 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
536 if (name == NULL)
537 name = "(null)";
538 else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
539 name = bfd_section_name (abfd, sym_sec);
540
541 return name;
542 }
543
544 /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
545 sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
546 pointers. */
547
548 typedef union elf_internal_group {
549 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
550 unsigned int flags;
551 } Elf_Internal_Group;
552
553 /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
554 signature just a string? */
555
556 static const char *
557 group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
558 {
559 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
560 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
561 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
562 Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
563
564 /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
565 that it is a symbol table section. */
566 if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
567 return NULL;
568 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
569 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
570 || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
571 return NULL;
572
573 /* Go read the symbol. */
574 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
575 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
576 &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
577 return NULL;
578
579 return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
580 }
581
582 /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
583
584 static bfd_boolean
585 setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
586 {
587 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
588
589 /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
590 is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
591 if (num_group == 0)
592 {
593 unsigned int i, shnum;
594
595 /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
596 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
597 shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
598 num_group = 0;
599
600 #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize) \
601 ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
602 && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize \
603 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
604 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
605
606 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
607 {
608 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
609
610 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
611 num_group += 1;
612 }
613
614 if (num_group == 0)
615 {
616 num_group = (unsigned) -1;
617 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
618 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
619 }
620 else
621 {
622 /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
623 so we can find them quickly. */
624 bfd_size_type amt;
625
626 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
627 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **)
628 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_group, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
629 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
630 return FALSE;
631 memset (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr, 0,
632 num_group * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
633 num_group = 0;
634
635 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
636 {
637 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
638
639 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
640 {
641 unsigned char *src;
642 Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
643
644 /* Make sure the group section has a BFD section
645 attached to it. */
646 if (!bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
647 return FALSE;
648
649 /* Add to list of sections. */
650 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
651 num_group += 1;
652
653 /* Read the raw contents. */
654 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4);
655 amt = shdr->sh_size * sizeof (*dest) / 4;
656 shdr->contents = (unsigned char *)
657 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, shdr->sh_size, sizeof (*dest) / 4);
658 /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers. */
659 if (shdr->contents == NULL)
660 {
661 _bfd_error_handler
662 /* xgettext:c-format */
663 (_("%pB: corrupt size field in group section"
664 " header: %#" PRIx64),
665 abfd, (uint64_t) shdr->sh_size);
666 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
667 -- num_group;
668 continue;
669 }
670
671 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
672
673 if (bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
674 || (bfd_bread (shdr->contents, shdr->sh_size, abfd)
675 != shdr->sh_size))
676 {
677 _bfd_error_handler
678 /* xgettext:c-format */
679 (_("%pB: invalid size field in group section"
680 " header: %#" PRIx64 ""),
681 abfd, (uint64_t) shdr->sh_size);
682 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
683 -- num_group;
684 /* PR 17510: If the group contents are even
685 partially corrupt, do not allow any of the
686 contents to be used. */
687 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
688 continue;
689 }
690
691 /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
692 array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
693 to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
694 pointers. */
695 src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
696 dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
697
698 while (1)
699 {
700 unsigned int idx;
701
702 src -= 4;
703 --dest;
704 idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
705 if (src == shdr->contents)
706 {
707 dest->flags = idx;
708 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
709 shdr->bfd_section->flags
710 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
711 break;
712 }
713 if (idx < shnum)
714 {
715 dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
716 /* PR binutils/23199: All sections in a
717 section group should be marked with
718 SHF_GROUP. But some tools generate
719 broken objects without SHF_GROUP. Fix
720 them up here. */
721 dest->shdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
722 }
723 if (idx >= shnum
724 || dest->shdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
725 {
726 _bfd_error_handler
727 (_("%pB: invalid entry in SHT_GROUP section [%u]"),
728 abfd, i);
729 dest->shdr = NULL;
730 }
731 }
732 }
733 }
734
735 /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups. */
736 if (num_group != (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group)
737 {
738 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
739
740 /* If all groups are invalid then fail. */
741 if (num_group == 0)
742 {
743 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
744 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group = -1;
745 _bfd_error_handler
746 (_("%pB: no valid group sections found"), abfd);
747 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
748 }
749 }
750 }
751 }
752
753 if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
754 {
755 unsigned int search_offset = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset;
756 unsigned int j;
757
758 for (j = 0; j < num_group; j++)
759 {
760 /* Begin search from previous found group. */
761 unsigned i = (j + search_offset) % num_group;
762
763 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
764 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
765 bfd_size_type n_elt;
766
767 if (shdr == NULL)
768 continue;
769
770 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
771 if (idx == NULL || shdr->sh_size < 4)
772 {
773 /* See PR 21957 for a reproducer. */
774 /* xgettext:c-format */
775 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: group section '%pA' has no contents"),
776 abfd, shdr->bfd_section);
777 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i] = NULL;
778 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
779 return FALSE;
780 }
781 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
782
783 /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
784 section is a member. */
785 while (--n_elt != 0)
786 if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
787 {
788 asection *s = NULL;
789
790 /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
791 other members to see if any others are linked via
792 next_in_group. */
793 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
794 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
795 while (--n_elt != 0)
796 if ((++idx)->shdr != NULL
797 && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
798 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
799 break;
800 if (n_elt != 0)
801 {
802 /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
803 insert current section in circular list. */
804 elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
805 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
806 elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
807 }
808 else
809 {
810 const char *gname;
811
812 gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
813 if (gname == NULL)
814 return FALSE;
815 elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
816
817 /* Start a circular list with one element. */
818 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
819 }
820
821 /* If the group section has been created, point to the
822 new member. */
823 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
824 elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
825
826 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset = i;
827 j = num_group - 1;
828 break;
829 }
830 }
831 }
832
833 if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
834 {
835 /* xgettext:c-format */
836 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: no group info for section '%pA'"),
837 abfd, newsect);
838 return FALSE;
839 }
840 return TRUE;
841 }
842
843 bfd_boolean
844 _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
845 {
846 unsigned int i;
847 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
848 bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
849 asection *s;
850
851 /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
852 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
853 {
854 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
855 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
856 {
857 unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
858 /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
859 not set the sh_link or sh_info fields. Hence we could
860 get the situation where elfsec is 0. */
861 if (elfsec == 0)
862 {
863 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
864 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
865 bed->link_order_error_handler
866 /* xgettext:c-format */
867 (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
868 abfd, s);
869 }
870 else
871 {
872 asection *linksec = NULL;
873
874 if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
875 {
876 this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
877 linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
878 }
879
880 /* PR 1991, 2008:
881 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
882 sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
883 if (linksec == NULL)
884 {
885 _bfd_error_handler
886 /* xgettext:c-format */
887 (_("%pB: sh_link [%d] in section `%pA' is incorrect"),
888 s->owner, elfsec, s);
889 result = FALSE;
890 }
891
892 elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
893 }
894 }
895 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP
896 && elf_next_in_group (s) == NULL)
897 {
898 _bfd_error_handler
899 /* xgettext:c-format */
900 (_("%pB: SHT_GROUP section [index %d] has no SHF_GROUP sections"),
901 abfd, elf_section_data (s)->this_idx);
902 result = FALSE;
903 }
904 }
905
906 /* Process section groups. */
907 if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
908 return result;
909
910 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
911 {
912 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
913 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
914 unsigned int n_elt;
915
916 /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data. */
917 if (shdr == NULL || shdr->bfd_section == NULL || shdr->contents == NULL)
918 {
919 _bfd_error_handler
920 /* xgettext:c-format */
921 (_("%pB: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
922 abfd, i);
923 result = FALSE;
924 continue;
925 }
926
927 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
928 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
929
930 while (--n_elt != 0)
931 {
932 ++ idx;
933
934 if (idx->shdr == NULL)
935 continue;
936 else if (idx->shdr->bfd_section)
937 elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
938 else if (idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA
939 && idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_REL)
940 {
941 /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
942 _bfd_error_handler
943 /* xgettext:c-format */
944 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s' in group [%pA]"),
945 abfd,
946 idx->shdr->sh_type,
947 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
948 (elf_elfheader (abfd)
949 ->e_shstrndx),
950 idx->shdr->sh_name),
951 shdr->bfd_section);
952 result = FALSE;
953 }
954 }
955 }
956
957 return result;
958 }
959
960 bfd_boolean
961 bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
962 {
963 return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
964 }
965
966 static char *
967 convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
968 {
969 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
970 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
971 if (new_name == NULL)
972 return NULL;
973 new_name[0] = '.';
974 new_name[1] = 'z';
975 memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
976 return new_name;
977 }
978
979 static char *
980 convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
981 {
982 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
983 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
984 if (new_name == NULL)
985 return NULL;
986 new_name[0] = '.';
987 memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
988 return new_name;
989 }
990
991 /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
992 BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
993
994 bfd_boolean
995 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
996 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
997 const char *name,
998 int shindex)
999 {
1000 asection *newsect;
1001 flagword flags;
1002 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1003
1004 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
1005 return TRUE;
1006
1007 newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
1008 if (newsect == NULL)
1009 return FALSE;
1010
1011 hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
1012 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
1013 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
1014
1015 /* Always use the real type/flags. */
1016 elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
1017 elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
1018
1019 newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
1020
1021 if (! bfd_set_section_vma (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_addr)
1022 || ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_size)
1023 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, newsect,
1024 bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
1025 return FALSE;
1026
1027 flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
1028 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1029 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
1030 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
1031 flags |= SEC_GROUP;
1032 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
1033 {
1034 flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
1035 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1036 flags |= SEC_LOAD;
1037 }
1038 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
1039 flags |= SEC_READONLY;
1040 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
1041 flags |= SEC_CODE;
1042 else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1043 flags |= SEC_DATA;
1044 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
1045 {
1046 flags |= SEC_MERGE;
1047 newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
1048 }
1049 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
1050 flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
1051 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
1052 if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
1053 return FALSE;
1054 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
1055 flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
1056 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
1057 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1058
1059 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
1060 {
1061 /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
1062 not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
1063 if (name [0] == '.')
1064 {
1065 const char *p;
1066 int n;
1067 if (name[1] == 'd')
1068 p = ".debug", n = 6;
1069 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'n')
1070 p = ".gnu.linkonce.wi.", n = 17;
1071 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'd')
1072 p = ".gdb_index", n = 11; /* yes we really do mean 11. */
1073 else if (name[1] == 'l')
1074 p = ".line", n = 5;
1075 else if (name[1] == 's')
1076 p = ".stab", n = 5;
1077 else if (name[1] == 'z')
1078 p = ".zdebug", n = 7;
1079 else
1080 p = NULL, n = 0;
1081 if (p != NULL && strncmp (name, p, n) == 0)
1082 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
1083 }
1084 }
1085
1086 /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
1087 only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
1088 g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
1089 The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
1090 are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
1091 all but one of the sections. */
1092 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
1093 && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
1094 flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
1095
1096 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1097 if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
1098 if (! bed->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags, hdr))
1099 return FALSE;
1100
1101 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags))
1102 return FALSE;
1103
1104 /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
1105 separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
1106 PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
1107 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
1108 {
1109 bfd_byte *contents;
1110
1111 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
1112 return FALSE;
1113
1114 elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size,
1115 hdr->sh_offset, hdr->sh_addralign);
1116 free (contents);
1117 }
1118
1119 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1120 {
1121 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
1122 unsigned int i, nload;
1123
1124 /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
1125 p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
1126 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
1127 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
1128 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1129 for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1130 if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
1131 break;
1132 else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
1133 ++nload;
1134 if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
1135 return TRUE;
1136
1137 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1138 for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1139 {
1140 if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
1141 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
1142 || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
1143 && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
1144 {
1145 if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
1146 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1147 + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr);
1148 else
1149 /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
1150 sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
1151 is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
1152 Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
1153 the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
1154 segment will contain sections with contiguous
1155 LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
1156 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1157 + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset);
1158
1159 /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
1160 offsets whether a section with zero size should
1161 be placed at the end of one segment or the
1162 beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
1163 if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
1164 && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
1165 <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
1166 break;
1167 }
1168 }
1169 }
1170
1171 /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1172 .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1173 if ((flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
1174 && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
1175 || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
1176 {
1177 enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
1178 int compression_header_size;
1179 bfd_size_type uncompressed_size;
1180 bfd_boolean compressed
1181 = bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd, newsect,
1182 &compression_header_size,
1183 &uncompressed_size);
1184
1185 if (compressed)
1186 {
1187 /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1188 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
1189 action = decompress;
1190 }
1191
1192 /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
1193 section. Check if we should compress. */
1194 if (action == nothing)
1195 {
1196 if (newsect->size != 0
1197 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS)
1198 && compression_header_size >= 0
1199 && uncompressed_size > 0
1200 && (!compressed
1201 || ((compression_header_size > 0)
1202 != ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0))))
1203 action = compress;
1204 else
1205 return TRUE;
1206 }
1207
1208 if (action == compress)
1209 {
1210 if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
1211 {
1212 _bfd_error_handler
1213 /* xgettext:c-format */
1214 (_("%pB: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
1215 abfd, name);
1216 return FALSE;
1217 }
1218 }
1219 else
1220 {
1221 if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
1222 {
1223 _bfd_error_handler
1224 /* xgettext:c-format */
1225 (_("%pB: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
1226 abfd, name);
1227 return FALSE;
1228 }
1229 }
1230
1231 if (abfd->is_linker_input)
1232 {
1233 if (name[1] == 'z'
1234 && (action == decompress
1235 || (action == compress
1236 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0)))
1237 {
1238 /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
1239 that linker will consider this section as a debug
1240 section. */
1241 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
1242 if (new_name == NULL)
1243 return FALSE;
1244 bfd_rename_section (abfd, newsect, new_name);
1245 }
1246 }
1247 else
1248 /* For objdump, don't rename the section. For objcopy, delay
1249 section rename to elf_fake_sections. */
1250 newsect->flags |= SEC_ELF_RENAME;
1251 }
1252
1253 return TRUE;
1254 }
1255
1256 const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] =
1257 {
1258 "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1259 "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1260 "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1261 };
1262
1263 /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1264 output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1265 has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1266 be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1267 change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1268 all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1269 into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1270 function. It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1271 relocatable output against an external symbol. */
1272
1273 bfd_reloc_status_type
1274 bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1275 arelent *reloc_entry,
1276 asymbol *symbol,
1277 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1278 asection *input_section,
1279 bfd *output_bfd,
1280 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1281 {
1282 if (output_bfd != NULL
1283 && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1284 && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1285 || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1286 {
1287 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1288 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1289 }
1290
1291 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1292 }
1293 \f
1294 /* Returns TRUE if section A matches section B.
1295 Names, addresses and links may be different, but everything else
1296 should be the same. */
1297
1298 static bfd_boolean
1299 section_match (const Elf_Internal_Shdr * a,
1300 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * b)
1301 {
1302 return
1303 a->sh_type == b->sh_type
1304 && (a->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1305 == (b->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1306 && a->sh_addralign == b->sh_addralign
1307 && a->sh_size == b->sh_size
1308 && a->sh_entsize == b->sh_entsize
1309 /* FIXME: Check sh_addr ? */
1310 ;
1311 }
1312
1313 /* Find a section in OBFD that has the same characteristics
1314 as IHEADER. Return the index of this section or SHN_UNDEF if
1315 none can be found. Check's section HINT first, as this is likely
1316 to be the correct section. */
1317
1318 static unsigned int
1319 find_link (const bfd *obfd, const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1320 const unsigned int hint)
1321 {
1322 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1323 unsigned int i;
1324
1325 BFD_ASSERT (iheader != NULL);
1326
1327 /* See PR 20922 for a reproducer of the NULL test. */
1328 if (hint < elf_numsections (obfd)
1329 && oheaders[hint] != NULL
1330 && section_match (oheaders[hint], iheader))
1331 return hint;
1332
1333 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1334 {
1335 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1336
1337 if (oheader == NULL)
1338 continue;
1339 if (section_match (oheader, iheader))
1340 /* FIXME: Do we care if there is a potential for
1341 multiple matches ? */
1342 return i;
1343 }
1344
1345 return SHN_UNDEF;
1346 }
1347
1348 /* PR 19938: Attempt to set the ELF section header fields of an OS or
1349 Processor specific section, based upon a matching input section.
1350 Returns TRUE upon success, FALSE otherwise. */
1351
1352 static bfd_boolean
1353 copy_special_section_fields (const bfd *ibfd,
1354 bfd *obfd,
1355 const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1356 Elf_Internal_Shdr *oheader,
1357 const unsigned int secnum)
1358 {
1359 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1360 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1361 bfd_boolean changed = FALSE;
1362 unsigned int sh_link;
1363
1364 if (oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS)
1365 {
1366 /* This is a feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug:
1367 When a section's type is changed to NOBITS, we preserve
1368 the sh_link and sh_info fields so that they can be
1369 matched up with the original.
1370
1371 Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
1372 The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
1373 relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
1374 the same location as they were in the input BFD. But
1375 the whole point of this action is to preserve the
1376 original values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so
1377 that they can be matched up with the section headers in
1378 the original file. So strictly speaking we may be
1379 creating an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file
1380 that just contains debug info and only for sections
1381 without any contents. */
1382 if (oheader->sh_link == 0)
1383 oheader->sh_link = iheader->sh_link;
1384 if (oheader->sh_info == 0)
1385 oheader->sh_info = iheader->sh_info;
1386 return TRUE;
1387 }
1388
1389 /* Allow the target a chance to decide how these fields should be set. */
1390 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL
1391 && bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields
1392 (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader))
1393 return TRUE;
1394
1395 /* We have an iheader which might match oheader, and which has non-zero
1396 sh_info and/or sh_link fields. Attempt to follow those links and find
1397 the section in the output bfd which corresponds to the linked section
1398 in the input bfd. */
1399 if (iheader->sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1400 {
1401 /* See PR 20931 for a reproducer. */
1402 if (iheader->sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
1403 {
1404 _bfd_error_handler
1405 /* xgettext:c-format */
1406 (_("%pB: invalid sh_link field (%d) in section number %d"),
1407 ibfd, iheader->sh_link, secnum);
1408 return FALSE;
1409 }
1410
1411 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_link], iheader->sh_link);
1412 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1413 {
1414 oheader->sh_link = sh_link;
1415 changed = TRUE;
1416 }
1417 else
1418 /* FIXME: Should we install iheader->sh_link
1419 if we could not find a match ? */
1420 _bfd_error_handler
1421 /* xgettext:c-format */
1422 (_("%pB: failed to find link section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1423 }
1424
1425 if (iheader->sh_info)
1426 {
1427 /* The sh_info field can hold arbitrary information, but if the
1428 SHF_LINK_INFO flag is set then it should be interpreted as a
1429 section index. */
1430 if (iheader->sh_flags & SHF_INFO_LINK)
1431 {
1432 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_info],
1433 iheader->sh_info);
1434 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1435 oheader->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
1436 }
1437 else
1438 /* No idea what it means - just copy it. */
1439 sh_link = iheader->sh_info;
1440
1441 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1442 {
1443 oheader->sh_info = sh_link;
1444 changed = TRUE;
1445 }
1446 else
1447 _bfd_error_handler
1448 /* xgettext:c-format */
1449 (_("%pB: failed to find info section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1450 }
1451
1452 return changed;
1453 }
1454
1455 /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1456 another. */
1457
1458 bfd_boolean
1459 _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1460 {
1461 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1462 Elf_Internal_Shdr **oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1463 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1464 unsigned int i;
1465
1466 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1467 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1468 return TRUE;
1469
1470 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
1471 {
1472 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1473 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
1474 }
1475
1476 elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1477
1478 /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
1479 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
1480 elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
1481
1482 /* If set, copy the EI_ABIVERSION field. */
1483 if (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION])
1484 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION]
1485 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION];
1486
1487 /* Copy object attributes. */
1488 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1489
1490 if (iheaders == NULL || oheaders == NULL)
1491 return TRUE;
1492
1493 bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1494
1495 /* Possibly copy other fields in the section header. */
1496 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1497 {
1498 unsigned int j;
1499 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1500
1501 /* Ignore ordinary sections. SHT_NOBITS sections are considered however
1502 because of a special case need for generating separate debug info
1503 files. See below for more details. */
1504 if (oheader == NULL
1505 || (oheader->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
1506 && oheader->sh_type < SHT_LOOS))
1507 continue;
1508
1509 /* Ignore empty sections, and sections whose
1510 fields have already been initialised. */
1511 if (oheader->sh_size == 0
1512 || (oheader->sh_info != 0 && oheader->sh_link != 0))
1513 continue;
1514
1515 /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
1516 First we try for a direct mapping between the input and output sections. */
1517 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1518 {
1519 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1520
1521 if (iheader == NULL)
1522 continue;
1523
1524 if (oheader->bfd_section != NULL
1525 && iheader->bfd_section != NULL
1526 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section != NULL
1527 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section == oheader->bfd_section)
1528 {
1529 /* We have found a connection from the input section to the
1530 output section. Attempt to copy the header fields. If
1531 this fails then do not try any further sections - there
1532 should only be a one-to-one mapping between input and output. */
1533 if (! copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1534 j = elf_numsections (ibfd);
1535 break;
1536 }
1537 }
1538
1539 if (j < elf_numsections (ibfd))
1540 continue;
1541
1542 /* That failed. So try to deduce the corresponding input section.
1543 Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
1544 is empty, so instead we check size, address and type. */
1545 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1546 {
1547 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1548
1549 if (iheader == NULL)
1550 continue;
1551
1552 /* Try matching fields in the input section's header.
1553 Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections into
1554 SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type matches any
1555 input type. */
1556 if ((oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
1557 || iheader->sh_type == oheader->sh_type)
1558 && (iheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1559 == (oheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1560 && iheader->sh_addralign == oheader->sh_addralign
1561 && iheader->sh_entsize == oheader->sh_entsize
1562 && iheader->sh_size == oheader->sh_size
1563 && iheader->sh_addr == oheader->sh_addr
1564 && (iheader->sh_info != oheader->sh_info
1565 || iheader->sh_link != oheader->sh_link))
1566 {
1567 if (copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1568 break;
1569 }
1570 }
1571
1572 if (j == elf_numsections (ibfd) && oheader->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS)
1573 {
1574 /* Final attempt. Call the backend copy function
1575 with a NULL input section. */
1576 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL)
1577 bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, NULL, oheader);
1578 }
1579 }
1580
1581 return TRUE;
1582 }
1583
1584 static const char *
1585 get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1586 {
1587 const char *pt;
1588 switch (p_type)
1589 {
1590 case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1591 case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1592 case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1593 case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1594 case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1595 case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1596 case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1597 case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1598 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1599 case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1600 case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1601 default: pt = NULL; break;
1602 }
1603 return pt;
1604 }
1605
1606 /* Print out the program headers. */
1607
1608 bfd_boolean
1609 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1610 {
1611 FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
1612 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1613 asection *s;
1614 bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1615
1616 p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1617 if (p != NULL)
1618 {
1619 unsigned int i, c;
1620
1621 fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1622 c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1623 for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1624 {
1625 const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1626 char buf[20];
1627
1628 if (pt == NULL)
1629 {
1630 sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1631 pt = buf;
1632 }
1633 fprintf (f, "%8s off 0x", pt);
1634 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1635 fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1636 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1637 fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1638 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1639 fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1640 fprintf (f, " filesz 0x");
1641 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1642 fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1643 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1644 fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1645 (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1646 (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1647 (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1648 if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1649 fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1650 fprintf (f, "\n");
1651 }
1652 }
1653
1654 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1655 if (s != NULL)
1656 {
1657 unsigned int elfsec;
1658 unsigned long shlink;
1659 bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1660 size_t extdynsize;
1661 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1662
1663 fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1664
1665 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1666 goto error_return;
1667
1668 elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1669 if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
1670 goto error_return;
1671 shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1672
1673 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1674 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1675
1676 extdyn = dynbuf;
1677 /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532. */
1678 if (s->size < extdynsize)
1679 goto error_return;
1680 extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1681 /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
1682 Fix range check. */
1683 for (; extdyn <= (extdynend - extdynsize); extdyn += extdynsize)
1684 {
1685 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1686 const char *name = "";
1687 char ab[20];
1688 bfd_boolean stringp;
1689 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1690
1691 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1692
1693 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1694 break;
1695
1696 stringp = FALSE;
1697 switch (dyn.d_tag)
1698 {
1699 default:
1700 if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
1701 name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
1702
1703 if (!strcmp (name, ""))
1704 {
1705 sprintf (ab, "%#" BFD_VMA_FMT "x", dyn.d_tag);
1706 name = ab;
1707 }
1708 break;
1709
1710 case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1711 case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1712 case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1713 case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1714 case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1715 case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1716 case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1717 case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1718 case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1719 case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1720 case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1721 case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1722 case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1723 case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1724 case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1725 case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1726 case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1727 case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1728 case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1729 case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1730 case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1731 case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1732 case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1733 case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1734 case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1735 case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1736 case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1737 case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1738 case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1739 case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1740 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1741 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1742 case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1743 case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1744 case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1745 case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1746 case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1747 case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1748 case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1749 case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1750 case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1751 case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1752 case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1753 case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1754 case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1755 case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1756 case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1757 case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1758 case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1759 case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1760 case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1761 case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1762 case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1763 case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1764 case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1765 case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1766 case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1767 case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1768 }
1769
1770 fprintf (f, " %-20s ", name);
1771 if (! stringp)
1772 {
1773 fprintf (f, "0x");
1774 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
1775 }
1776 else
1777 {
1778 const char *string;
1779 unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1780
1781 string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1782 if (string == NULL)
1783 goto error_return;
1784 fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1785 }
1786 fprintf (f, "\n");
1787 }
1788
1789 free (dynbuf);
1790 dynbuf = NULL;
1791 }
1792
1793 if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1794 || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1795 {
1796 if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
1797 return FALSE;
1798 }
1799
1800 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1801 {
1802 Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1803
1804 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1805 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1806 {
1807 fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1808 t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1809 t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1810 if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1811 {
1812 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1813
1814 fprintf (f, "\t");
1815 for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1816 a != NULL;
1817 a = a->vda_nextptr)
1818 fprintf (f, "%s ",
1819 a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1820 fprintf (f, "\n");
1821 }
1822 }
1823 }
1824
1825 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1826 {
1827 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1828
1829 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1830 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1831 {
1832 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1833
1834 fprintf (f, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1835 t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1836 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1837 fprintf (f, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1838 a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1839 a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1840 }
1841 }
1842
1843 return TRUE;
1844
1845 error_return:
1846 if (dynbuf != NULL)
1847 free (dynbuf);
1848 return FALSE;
1849 }
1850
1851 /* Get version string. */
1852
1853 const char *
1854 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1855 bfd_boolean *hidden)
1856 {
1857 const char *version_string = NULL;
1858 if (elf_dynversym (abfd) != 0
1859 && (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0))
1860 {
1861 unsigned int vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version;
1862
1863 *hidden = (vernum & VERSYM_HIDDEN) != 0;
1864 vernum &= VERSYM_VERSION;
1865
1866 if (vernum == 0)
1867 version_string = "";
1868 else if (vernum == 1
1869 && (vernum > elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs
1870 || (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[0].vd_flags
1871 == VER_FLG_BASE)))
1872 version_string = "Base";
1873 else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1874 version_string =
1875 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1876 else
1877 {
1878 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1879
1880 version_string = _("<corrupt>");
1881 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1882 t != NULL;
1883 t = t->vn_nextref)
1884 {
1885 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1886
1887 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1888 {
1889 if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1890 {
1891 version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1892 break;
1893 }
1894 }
1895 }
1896 }
1897 }
1898 return version_string;
1899 }
1900
1901 /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1902
1903 void
1904 bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1905 void *filep,
1906 asymbol *symbol,
1907 bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1908 {
1909 FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
1910 switch (how)
1911 {
1912 case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1913 fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1914 break;
1915 case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1916 fprintf (file, "elf ");
1917 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1918 fprintf (file, " %x", symbol->flags);
1919 break;
1920 case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1921 {
1922 const char *section_name;
1923 const char *name = NULL;
1924 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1925 unsigned char st_other;
1926 bfd_vma val;
1927 const char *version_string;
1928 bfd_boolean hidden;
1929
1930 section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1931
1932 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1933 if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1934 name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1935
1936 if (name == NULL)
1937 {
1938 name = symbol->name;
1939 bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1940 }
1941
1942 fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1943 /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
1944 we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1945 For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1946 we've printed the address; now print the size. */
1947 if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1948 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
1949 else
1950 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
1951 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
1952
1953 /* If we have version information, print it. */
1954 version_string = _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd,
1955 symbol,
1956 &hidden);
1957 if (version_string)
1958 {
1959 if (!hidden)
1960 fprintf (file, " %-11s", version_string);
1961 else
1962 {
1963 int i;
1964
1965 fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
1966 for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
1967 putc (' ', file);
1968 }
1969 }
1970
1971 /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
1972 st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
1973
1974 switch (st_other)
1975 {
1976 case 0: break;
1977 case STV_INTERNAL: fprintf (file, " .internal"); break;
1978 case STV_HIDDEN: fprintf (file, " .hidden"); break;
1979 case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
1980 default:
1981 /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
1982 everything hex. */
1983 fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
1984 }
1985
1986 fprintf (file, " %s", name);
1987 }
1988 break;
1989 }
1990 }
1991 \f
1992 /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
1993
1994 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
1995
1996 bfd_boolean
1997 bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
1998 {
1999 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
2000 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
2001 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2002 const char *name;
2003 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
2004 static bfd_boolean * sections_being_created = NULL;
2005 static bfd * sections_being_created_abfd = NULL;
2006 static unsigned int nesting = 0;
2007
2008 if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2009 return FALSE;
2010
2011 if (++ nesting > 3)
2012 {
2013 /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a recursive group of
2014 sections, with each the string indices pointing to the next in the
2015 loop. Detect this here, by refusing to load a section that we are
2016 already in the process of loading. We only trigger this test if
2017 we have nested at least three sections deep as normal ELF binaries
2018 can expect to recurse at least once.
2019
2020 FIXME: It would be better if this array was attached to the bfd,
2021 rather than being held in a static pointer. */
2022
2023 if (sections_being_created_abfd != abfd)
2024 sections_being_created = NULL;
2025 if (sections_being_created == NULL)
2026 {
2027 /* FIXME: It would be more efficient to attach this array to the bfd somehow. */
2028 sections_being_created = (bfd_boolean *)
2029 bfd_zalloc (abfd, elf_numsections (abfd) * sizeof (bfd_boolean));
2030 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2031 }
2032 if (sections_being_created [shindex])
2033 {
2034 _bfd_error_handler
2035 (_("%pB: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd);
2036 return FALSE;
2037 }
2038 sections_being_created [shindex] = TRUE;
2039 }
2040
2041 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
2042 ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
2043 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
2044 hdr->sh_name);
2045 if (name == NULL)
2046 goto fail;
2047
2048 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2049 switch (hdr->sh_type)
2050 {
2051 case SHT_NULL:
2052 /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
2053 goto success;
2054
2055 case SHT_PROGBITS: /* Normal section with contents. */
2056 case SHT_NOBITS: /* .bss section. */
2057 case SHT_HASH: /* .hash section. */
2058 case SHT_NOTE: /* .note section. */
2059 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY: /* .init_array section. */
2060 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY: /* .fini_array section. */
2061 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY: /* .preinit_array section. */
2062 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
2063 case SHT_GNU_HASH: /* .gnu.hash section. */
2064 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2065 goto success;
2066
2067 case SHT_DYNAMIC: /* Dynamic linking information. */
2068 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2069 goto fail;
2070
2071 if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
2072 {
2073 /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
2074 field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
2075 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
2076 {
2077 case bfd_arch_i386:
2078 case bfd_arch_sparc:
2079 if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
2080 || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
2081 break;
2082 /* Otherwise fall through. */
2083 default:
2084 goto fail;
2085 }
2086 }
2087 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
2088 goto fail;
2089 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
2090 {
2091 Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
2092
2093 /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
2094 sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
2095 string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
2096 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2097 {
2098 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
2099 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2100 }
2101 else
2102 {
2103 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2104
2105 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2106 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2107 {
2108 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2109 if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2110 {
2111 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2112 break;
2113 }
2114 }
2115 }
2116 }
2117 goto success;
2118
2119 case SHT_SYMTAB: /* A symbol table. */
2120 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2121 goto success;
2122
2123 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2124 goto fail;
2125
2126 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2127 {
2128 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2129 goto fail;
2130 /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2131 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2132 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2133 hdr->sh_info = 0;
2134 goto success;
2135 }
2136
2137 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one symbol table.
2138 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2139 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) != 0)
2140 {
2141 _bfd_error_handler
2142 /* xgettext:c-format */
2143 (_("%pB: warning: multiple symbol tables detected"
2144 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2145 abfd, shindex);
2146 goto success;
2147 }
2148 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2149 elf_symtab_hdr (abfd) = *hdr;
2150 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2151 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2152
2153 /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
2154 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
2155 treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
2156 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
2157 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
2158 linker. */
2159 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
2160 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
2161 && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2162 shindex))
2163 goto fail;
2164
2165 /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
2166 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
2167 is most likely specified by the next section header. */
2168 {
2169 elf_section_list * entry;
2170 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2171
2172 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2173 if (entry->hdr.sh_link == shindex)
2174 goto success;
2175
2176 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2177 for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2178 {
2179 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2180
2181 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2182 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2183 break;
2184 }
2185
2186 if (i == num_sec)
2187 for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
2188 {
2189 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2190
2191 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2192 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2193 break;
2194 }
2195
2196 if (i != shindex)
2197 ret = bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
2198 /* else FIXME: we have failed to find the symbol table - should we issue an error ? */
2199 goto success;
2200 }
2201
2202 case SHT_DYNSYM: /* A dynamic symbol table. */
2203 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2204 goto success;
2205
2206 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2207 goto fail;
2208
2209 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2210 {
2211 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2212 goto fail;
2213
2214 /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2215 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2216 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2217 hdr->sh_info = 0;
2218 goto success;
2219 }
2220
2221 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one dynamic symbol table.
2222 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2223 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2224 {
2225 _bfd_error_handler
2226 /* xgettext:c-format */
2227 (_("%pB: warning: multiple dynamic symbol tables detected"
2228 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2229 abfd, shindex);
2230 goto success;
2231 }
2232 elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2233 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
2234 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
2235 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2236
2237 /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
2238 section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
2239 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2240 goto success;
2241
2242 case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections. */
2243 {
2244 elf_section_list * entry;
2245
2246 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2247 if (entry->ndx == shindex)
2248 goto success;
2249
2250 entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
2251 if (entry == NULL)
2252 goto fail;
2253 entry->ndx = shindex;
2254 entry->hdr = * hdr;
2255 entry->next = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
2256 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
2257 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = & entry->hdr;
2258 goto success;
2259 }
2260
2261 case SHT_STRTAB: /* A string table. */
2262 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
2263 goto success;
2264
2265 if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
2266 {
2267 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2268 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
2269 goto success;
2270 }
2271
2272 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2273 {
2274 symtab_strtab:
2275 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
2276 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
2277 goto success;
2278 }
2279
2280 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2281 {
2282 dynsymtab_strtab:
2283 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2284 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
2285 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
2286 /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
2287 can handle it. */
2288 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2289 shindex);
2290 goto success;
2291 }
2292
2293 /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
2294 regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
2295 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
2296 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
2297 {
2298 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2299
2300 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2301 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2302 {
2303 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2304 if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2305 {
2306 /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
2307 if (i == shindex)
2308 goto fail;
2309 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
2310 goto fail;
2311 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
2312 goto symtab_strtab;
2313 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
2314 goto dynsymtab_strtab;
2315 }
2316 }
2317 }
2318 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2319 goto success;
2320
2321 case SHT_REL:
2322 case SHT_RELA:
2323 /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
2324 {
2325 asection *target_sect;
2326 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
2327 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2328 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
2329
2330 if (hdr->sh_entsize
2331 != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
2332 ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
2333 goto fail;
2334
2335 /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
2336 if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
2337 {
2338 _bfd_error_handler
2339 /* xgettext:c-format */
2340 (_("%pB: invalid link %u for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
2341 abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex);
2342 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2343 shindex);
2344 goto success;
2345 }
2346
2347 /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
2348 libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
2349 bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
2350 reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
2351 them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
2352 one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
2353 to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
2354
2355 Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
2356 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
2357 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
2358 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
2359 {
2360 unsigned int scan;
2361 int found;
2362
2363 found = 0;
2364 for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
2365 {
2366 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2367 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2368 {
2369 if (found != 0)
2370 {
2371 found = 0;
2372 break;
2373 }
2374 found = scan;
2375 }
2376 }
2377 if (found != 0)
2378 hdr->sh_link = found;
2379 }
2380
2381 /* Get the symbol table. */
2382 if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2383 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2384 && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
2385 goto fail;
2386
2387 /* If this reloc section does not use the main symbol table we
2388 don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't adequately
2389 represent such a section, so at least for now, we don't
2390 try. We just present it as a normal section. We also
2391 can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the null
2392 section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or its
2393 sh_link points to the null section. */
2394 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
2395 || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
2396 || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
2397 || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
2398 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
2399 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2400 {
2401 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2402 shindex);
2403 goto success;
2404 }
2405
2406 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
2407 goto fail;
2408
2409 target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
2410 if (target_sect == NULL)
2411 goto fail;
2412
2413 esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
2414 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2415 p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
2416 else
2417 p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
2418
2419 /* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7. */
2420 if (*p_hdr != NULL)
2421 goto fail;
2422 hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*hdr2));
2423 if (hdr2 == NULL)
2424 goto fail;
2425 *hdr2 = *hdr;
2426 *p_hdr = hdr2;
2427 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
2428 target_sect->reloc_count += (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr)
2429 * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel);
2430 target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
2431 target_sect->relocation = NULL;
2432 target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
2433 /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
2434 its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
2435 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2436 {
2437 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2438 target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
2439 }
2440 abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
2441 goto success;
2442 }
2443
2444 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2445 elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
2446 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
2447 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2448 goto success;
2449
2450 case SHT_GNU_versym:
2451 if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
2452 goto fail;
2453
2454 elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
2455 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
2456 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2457 goto success;
2458
2459 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2460 elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
2461 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
2462 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2463 goto success;
2464
2465 case SHT_SHLIB:
2466 goto success;
2467
2468 case SHT_GROUP:
2469 if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
2470 goto fail;
2471
2472 if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2473 goto fail;
2474
2475 goto success;
2476
2477 default:
2478 /* Possibly an attributes section. */
2479 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
2480 || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
2481 {
2482 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2483 goto fail;
2484 _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
2485 goto success;
2486 }
2487
2488 /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
2489 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2490 goto success;
2491
2492 if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
2493 {
2494 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2495 /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
2496 for applications? */
2497 _bfd_error_handler
2498 /* xgettext:c-format */
2499 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2500 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2501 else
2502 {
2503 /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
2504 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2505 shindex);
2506 goto success;
2507 }
2508 }
2509 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
2510 && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
2511 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2512 _bfd_error_handler
2513 /* xgettext:c-format */
2514 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2515 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2516 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
2517 {
2518 /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
2519 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
2520 /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
2521 required to correctly process the section and the file should
2522 be rejected with an error message. */
2523 _bfd_error_handler
2524 /* xgettext:c-format */
2525 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2526 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2527 else
2528 {
2529 /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2530 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2531 goto success;
2532 }
2533 }
2534 else
2535 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2536 _bfd_error_handler
2537 /* xgettext:c-format */
2538 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2539 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2540
2541 goto fail;
2542 }
2543
2544 fail:
2545 ret = FALSE;
2546 success:
2547 if (sections_being_created && sections_being_created_abfd == abfd)
2548 sections_being_created [shindex] = FALSE;
2549 if (-- nesting == 0)
2550 {
2551 sections_being_created = NULL;
2552 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2553 }
2554 return ret;
2555 }
2556
2557 /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2558
2559 Elf_Internal_Sym *
2560 bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
2561 bfd *abfd,
2562 unsigned long r_symndx)
2563 {
2564 unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2565
2566 if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
2567 {
2568 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2569 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2570 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2571
2572 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2573 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2574 &cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2575 return NULL;
2576
2577 if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2578 {
2579 memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2580 cache->abfd = abfd;
2581 }
2582 cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2583 }
2584
2585 return &cache->sym[ent];
2586 }
2587
2588 /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2589 section. */
2590
2591 asection *
2592 bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
2593 {
2594 if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2595 return NULL;
2596 return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
2597 }
2598
2599 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2600 {
2601 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2602 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2603 };
2604
2605 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2606 {
2607 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2608 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2609 };
2610
2611 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2612 {
2613 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2614 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2615 /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
2616 unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
2617 attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler. */
2618 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2619 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2620 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2621 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2622 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2623 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, SHF_ALLOC },
2624 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, SHF_ALLOC },
2625 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, SHF_ALLOC },
2626 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2627 };
2628
2629 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2630 {
2631 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2632 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), -2, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2633 { NULL, 0 , 0, 0, 0 }
2634 };
2635
2636 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2637 {
2638 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2639 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_EXCLUDE },
2640 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2641 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym, 0 },
2642 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef, 0 },
2643 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2644 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2645 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA, SHF_ALLOC },
2646 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2647 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2648 };
2649
2650 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2651 {
2652 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2653 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2654 };
2655
2656 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2657 {
2658 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2659 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), -2, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2660 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2661 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2662 };
2663
2664 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2665 {
2666 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2667 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2668 };
2669
2670 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2671 {
2672 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2673 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
2674 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2675 };
2676
2677 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2678 {
2679 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), -2, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2680 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2681 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2682 };
2683
2684 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2685 {
2686 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2687 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2688 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA, 0 },
2689 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL, 0 },
2690 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2691 };
2692
2693 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2694 {
2695 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2696 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2697 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2698 /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2699 this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2700 { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2701 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2702 };
2703
2704 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2705 {
2706 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2707 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2708 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2709 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2710 };
2711
2712 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
2713 {
2714 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2715 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2716 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2717 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2718 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2719 };
2720
2721 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
2722 {
2723 special_sections_b, /* 'b' */
2724 special_sections_c, /* 'c' */
2725 special_sections_d, /* 'd' */
2726 NULL, /* 'e' */
2727 special_sections_f, /* 'f' */
2728 special_sections_g, /* 'g' */
2729 special_sections_h, /* 'h' */
2730 special_sections_i, /* 'i' */
2731 NULL, /* 'j' */
2732 NULL, /* 'k' */
2733 special_sections_l, /* 'l' */
2734 NULL, /* 'm' */
2735 special_sections_n, /* 'n' */
2736 NULL, /* 'o' */
2737 special_sections_p, /* 'p' */
2738 NULL, /* 'q' */
2739 special_sections_r, /* 'r' */
2740 special_sections_s, /* 's' */
2741 special_sections_t, /* 't' */
2742 NULL, /* 'u' */
2743 NULL, /* 'v' */
2744 NULL, /* 'w' */
2745 NULL, /* 'x' */
2746 NULL, /* 'y' */
2747 special_sections_z /* 'z' */
2748 };
2749
2750 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2751 _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2752 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2753 unsigned int rela)
2754 {
2755 int i;
2756 int len;
2757
2758 len = strlen (name);
2759
2760 for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2761 {
2762 int suffix_len;
2763 int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2764
2765 if (len < prefix_len)
2766 continue;
2767 if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2768 continue;
2769
2770 suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2771 if (suffix_len <= 0)
2772 {
2773 if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2774 {
2775 if (suffix_len == 0)
2776 continue;
2777 if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2778 && (suffix_len == -2
2779 || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2780 continue;
2781 }
2782 }
2783 else
2784 {
2785 if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2786 continue;
2787 if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2788 spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2789 suffix_len) != 0)
2790 continue;
2791 }
2792 return &spec[i];
2793 }
2794
2795 return NULL;
2796 }
2797
2798 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2799 _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2800 {
2801 int i;
2802 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2803 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2804
2805 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2806 if (sec->name == NULL)
2807 return NULL;
2808
2809 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2810 spec = bed->special_sections;
2811 if (spec)
2812 {
2813 spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2814 bed->special_sections,
2815 sec->use_rela_p);
2816 if (spec != NULL)
2817 return spec;
2818 }
2819
2820 if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2821 return NULL;
2822
2823 i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2824 if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
2825 return NULL;
2826
2827 spec = special_sections[i];
2828
2829 if (spec == NULL)
2830 return NULL;
2831
2832 return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2833 }
2834
2835 bfd_boolean
2836 _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2837 {
2838 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2839 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2840 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2841
2842 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2843 if (sdata == NULL)
2844 {
2845 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
2846 sizeof (*sdata));
2847 if (sdata == NULL)
2848 return FALSE;
2849 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2850 }
2851
2852 /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2853 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2854 sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2855
2856 /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
2857 flags. They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
2858 anyway. We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
2859 created sections. If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
2860 set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
2861 elf_fake_sections. Special handling for .init_array/.fini_array
2862 output sections since they may contain .ctors/.dtors input
2863 sections. We don't want _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data to
2864 copy ELF section type from .ctors/.dtors input sections. */
2865 if (abfd->direction != read_direction
2866 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
2867 {
2868 ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2869 if (ssect != NULL
2870 && (!sec->flags
2871 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
2872 || ssect->type == SHT_INIT_ARRAY
2873 || ssect->type == SHT_FINI_ARRAY))
2874 {
2875 elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2876 elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2877 }
2878 }
2879
2880 return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2881 }
2882
2883 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2884
2885 Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2886 of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2887 program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2888 generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2889
2890 Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2891 (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2892 system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2893 but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2894 file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2895 of combined data+bss.
2896
2897 To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2898 for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2899 the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2900 by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2901 into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2902
2903 */
2904
2905 bfd_boolean
2906 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2907 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2908 int hdr_index,
2909 const char *type_name)
2910 {
2911 asection *newsect;
2912 char *name;
2913 char namebuf[64];
2914 size_t len;
2915 int split;
2916
2917 split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2918 && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2919 && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2920
2921 if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2922 {
2923 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
2924 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2925 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2926 if (!name)
2927 return FALSE;
2928 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2929 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2930 if (newsect == NULL)
2931 return FALSE;
2932 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr;
2933 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr;
2934 newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2935 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2936 newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2937 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2938 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2939 {
2940 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2941 newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2942 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2943 {
2944 /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2945 may be data. */
2946 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2947 }
2948 }
2949 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2950 {
2951 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2952 }
2953 }
2954
2955 if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
2956 {
2957 bfd_vma align;
2958
2959 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
2960 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2961 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2962 if (!name)
2963 return FALSE;
2964 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2965 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2966 if (newsect == NULL)
2967 return FALSE;
2968 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2969 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2970 newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
2971 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
2972 align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
2973 if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
2974 align = hdr->p_align;
2975 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
2976 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2977 {
2978 /* Hack for gdb. Segments that have not been modified do
2979 not have their contents written to a core file, on the
2980 assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
2981 executable. We flag this case by setting the fake
2982 section size to zero. Note that "real" bss sections will
2983 always have their contents dumped to the core file. */
2984 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
2985 newsect->size = 0;
2986 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2987 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2988 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2989 }
2990 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2991 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2992 }
2993
2994 return TRUE;
2995 }
2996
2997 bfd_boolean
2998 bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
2999 {
3000 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3001
3002 switch (hdr->p_type)
3003 {
3004 case PT_NULL:
3005 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
3006
3007 case PT_LOAD:
3008 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load");
3009
3010 case PT_DYNAMIC:
3011 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
3012
3013 case PT_INTERP:
3014 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
3015
3016 case PT_NOTE:
3017 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
3018 return FALSE;
3019 if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz,
3020 hdr->p_align))
3021 return FALSE;
3022 return TRUE;
3023
3024 case PT_SHLIB:
3025 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
3026
3027 case PT_PHDR:
3028 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
3029
3030 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
3031 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
3032 "eh_frame_hdr");
3033
3034 case PT_GNU_STACK:
3035 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
3036
3037 case PT_GNU_RELRO:
3038 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
3039
3040 default:
3041 /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
3042 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3043 return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
3044 }
3045 }
3046
3047 /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
3048 REL or RELA. */
3049
3050 Elf_Internal_Shdr *
3051 _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
3052 {
3053 if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
3054 {
3055 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
3056 return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
3057 }
3058 else
3059 return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
3060 }
3061
3062 static bfd_boolean
3063 _bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd *abfd,
3064 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr,
3065 const char *sec_name,
3066 bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
3067 {
3068 char *name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
3069 sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name));
3070 if (name == NULL)
3071 return FALSE;
3072
3073 sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name);
3074 rel_hdr->sh_name =
3075 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
3076 FALSE);
3077 if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3078 return FALSE;
3079
3080 return TRUE;
3081 }
3082
3083 /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
3084 containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
3085 USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
3086 relocations. */
3087
3088 static bfd_boolean
3089 _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
3090 struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
3091 const char *sec_name,
3092 bfd_boolean use_rela_p,
3093 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p)
3094 {
3095 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
3096 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3097
3098 BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
3099 rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*rel_hdr));
3100 reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
3101
3102 if (delay_st_name_p)
3103 rel_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3104 else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd, rel_hdr, sec_name,
3105 use_rela_p))
3106 return FALSE;
3107 rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
3108 rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
3109 ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
3110 : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
3111 rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
3112 rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
3113 rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3114 rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3115 rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3116
3117 return TRUE;
3118 }
3119
3120 /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
3121
3122 int
3123 bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
3124 {
3125 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3126 && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
3127 return SHT_NOBITS;
3128 return SHT_PROGBITS;
3129 }
3130
3131 struct fake_section_arg
3132 {
3133 struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
3134 bfd_boolean failed;
3135 };
3136
3137 /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
3138
3139 static void
3140 elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
3141 {
3142 struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
3143 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3144 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
3145 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
3146 unsigned int sh_type;
3147 const char *name = asect->name;
3148 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p = FALSE;
3149
3150 if (arg->failed)
3151 {
3152 /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
3153 loop. */
3154 return;
3155 }
3156
3157 this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
3158
3159 if (arg->link_info)
3160 {
3161 /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*. */
3162 if ((arg->link_info->compress_debug & COMPRESS_DEBUG)
3163 && (asect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
3164 && name[1] == 'd'
3165 && name[6] == '_')
3166 {
3167 /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
3168 compressed. */
3169 asect->flags |= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS;
3170
3171 /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding section
3172 name to section name section after it is compressed in
3173 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3174 delay_st_name_p = TRUE;
3175 }
3176 }
3177 else if ((asect->flags & SEC_ELF_RENAME))
3178 {
3179 /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section. */
3180 if ((abfd->flags & (BFD_DECOMPRESS | BFD_COMPRESS_GABI)))
3181 {
3182 /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
3183 convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
3184 needed. */
3185 if (name[1] == 'z')
3186 {
3187 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
3188 if (new_name == NULL)
3189 {
3190 arg->failed = TRUE;
3191 return;
3192 }
3193 name = new_name;
3194 }
3195 }
3196 else if (asect->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE)
3197 {
3198 /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
3199 section smaller. So only rename the section when
3200 compression has actually taken place. If input section
3201 name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again. */
3202 char *new_name = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
3203 if (new_name == NULL)
3204 {
3205 arg->failed = TRUE;
3206 return;
3207 }
3208 BFD_ASSERT (name[1] != 'z');
3209 name = new_name;
3210 }
3211 }
3212
3213 if (delay_st_name_p)
3214 this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3215 else
3216 {
3217 this_hdr->sh_name
3218 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3219 name, FALSE);
3220 if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3221 {
3222 arg->failed = TRUE;
3223 return;
3224 }
3225 }
3226
3227 /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
3228
3229 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3230 || asect->user_set_vma)
3231 this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma;
3232 else
3233 this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3234
3235 this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3236 this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
3237 this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3238 /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee. */
3239 if (asect->alignment_power >= (sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 1)
3240 {
3241 _bfd_error_handler
3242 /* xgettext:c-format */
3243 (_("%pB: error: alignment power %d of section `%pA' is too big"),
3244 abfd, asect->alignment_power, asect);
3245 arg->failed = TRUE;
3246 return;
3247 }
3248 this_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power;
3249 /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
3250 copy_private_section_data. */
3251
3252 this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
3253 this_hdr->contents = NULL;
3254
3255 /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
3256 asect->flags. */
3257 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
3258 sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
3259 else
3260 sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
3261
3262 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
3263 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3264 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
3265 && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
3266 && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3267 {
3268 /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
3269 allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
3270 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
3271 to a bss output section via a linker script. */
3272 _bfd_error_handler
3273 (_("warning: section `%pA' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
3274 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3275 }
3276
3277 switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
3278 {
3279 default:
3280 break;
3281
3282 case SHT_STRTAB:
3283 case SHT_NOTE:
3284 case SHT_NOBITS:
3285 case SHT_PROGBITS:
3286 break;
3287
3288 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
3289 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
3290 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
3291 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
3292 break;
3293
3294 case SHT_HASH:
3295 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
3296 break;
3297
3298 case SHT_DYNSYM:
3299 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
3300 break;
3301
3302 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3303 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
3304 break;
3305
3306 case SHT_RELA:
3307 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
3308 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3309 break;
3310
3311 case SHT_REL:
3312 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
3313 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
3314 break;
3315
3316 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3317 this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
3318 break;
3319
3320 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3321 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3322 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3323 cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
3324 zero. */
3325 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3326 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
3327 else
3328 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
3329 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
3330 break;
3331
3332 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3333 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3334 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3335 cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
3336 zero. */
3337 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3338 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
3339 else
3340 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
3341 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
3342 break;
3343
3344 case SHT_GROUP:
3345 this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
3346 break;
3347
3348 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3349 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
3350 break;
3351 }
3352
3353 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3354 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
3355 if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3356 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
3357 if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
3358 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
3359 if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
3360 {
3361 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
3362 this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
3363 }
3364 if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
3365 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
3366 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
3367 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3368 if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
3369 {
3370 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
3371 if (asect->size == 0
3372 && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
3373 {
3374 struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
3375
3376 this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3377 if (o != NULL)
3378 {
3379 this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
3380 if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
3381 this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
3382 }
3383 }
3384 }
3385 if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
3386 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
3387
3388 /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
3389 SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
3390 this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
3391 create the other. */
3392 if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
3393 {
3394 /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
3395 needed. */
3396 if (arg->link_info
3397 /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
3398 && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
3399 && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg->link_info)
3400 || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
3401 {
3402 if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
3403 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, name,
3404 FALSE, delay_st_name_p))
3405 {
3406 arg->failed = TRUE;
3407 return;
3408 }
3409 if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
3410 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, name,
3411 TRUE, delay_st_name_p))
3412 {
3413 arg->failed = TRUE;
3414 return;
3415 }
3416 }
3417 else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
3418 (asect->use_rela_p
3419 ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
3420 name,
3421 asect->use_rela_p,
3422 delay_st_name_p))
3423 {
3424 arg->failed = TRUE;
3425 return;
3426 }
3427 }
3428
3429 /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
3430 sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
3431 if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
3432 && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
3433 {
3434 arg->failed = TRUE;
3435 return;
3436 }
3437
3438 if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
3439 {
3440 /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
3441 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
3442 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3443 }
3444 }
3445
3446 /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
3447 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
3448 when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
3449 from bfd_elf_final_link. */
3450
3451 void
3452 bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
3453 {
3454 bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
3455 asection *elt, *first;
3456 unsigned char *loc;
3457 bfd_boolean gas;
3458
3459 /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
3460 elfxx-ia64.c. */
3461 if (((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP)
3462 || *failedptr)
3463 return;
3464
3465 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
3466 {
3467 unsigned long symindx = 0;
3468
3469 /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
3470 generic linker. */
3471 if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
3472 symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
3473
3474 if (symindx == 0)
3475 {
3476 /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
3477 elf_section_syms. */
3478 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_syms (abfd) != NULL);
3479 symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
3480 }
3481 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
3482 }
3483 else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
3484 {
3485 /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
3486 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
3487 set until all local symbols are output. */
3488 asection *igroup;
3489 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data;
3490 unsigned long symndx;
3491 unsigned long extsymoff;
3492 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3493
3494 /* The point of this little dance to the first SHF_GROUP section
3495 then back to the SHT_GROUP section is that this gets us to
3496 the SHT_GROUP in the input object. */
3497 igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
3498 sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
3499 symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
3500 extsymoff = 0;
3501 if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
3502 {
3503 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3504
3505 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
3506 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3507 }
3508 h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
3509 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3510 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3511 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
3512
3513 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
3514 }
3515
3516 /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
3517 gas = TRUE;
3518 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3519 {
3520 gas = FALSE;
3521 sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
3522
3523 /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
3524 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
3525 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3526 {
3527 *failedptr = TRUE;
3528 return;
3529 }
3530 }
3531
3532 loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
3533
3534 /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
3535 squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
3536 start of the input section group. */
3537 first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
3538
3539 /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
3540 indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
3541 just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
3542 directives, not that it matters. */
3543 while (elt != NULL)
3544 {
3545 asection *s;
3546
3547 s = elt;
3548 if (!gas)
3549 s = s->output_section;
3550 if (s != NULL
3551 && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
3552 {
3553 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
3554 struct bfd_elf_section_data *input_elf_sec = elf_section_data (elt);
3555
3556 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3557 && (gas
3558 || (input_elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3559 && input_elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3560 {
3561 elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3562 loc -= 4;
3563 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rel.idx, loc);
3564 }
3565 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3566 && (gas
3567 || (input_elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3568 && input_elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3569 {
3570 elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3571 loc -= 4;
3572 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rela.idx, loc);
3573 }
3574 loc -= 4;
3575 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->this_idx, loc);
3576 }
3577 elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
3578 if (elt == first)
3579 break;
3580 }
3581
3582 loc -= 4;
3583 BFD_ASSERT (loc == sec->contents);
3584
3585 H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
3586 }
3587
3588 /* Given NAME, the name of a relocation section stripped of its
3589 .rel/.rela prefix, return the section in ABFD to which the
3590 relocations apply. */
3591
3592 asection *
3593 _bfd_elf_plt_get_reloc_section (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
3594 {
3595 /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
3596 section likely apply to .got.plt or .got section. */
3597 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->want_got_plt
3598 && strcmp (name, ".plt") == 0)
3599 {
3600 asection *sec;
3601
3602 name = ".got.plt";
3603 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3604 if (sec != NULL)
3605 return sec;
3606 name = ".got";
3607 }
3608
3609 return bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3610 }
3611
3612 /* Return the section to which RELOC_SEC applies. */
3613
3614 static asection *
3615 elf_get_reloc_section (asection *reloc_sec)
3616 {
3617 const char *name;
3618 unsigned int type;
3619 bfd *abfd;
3620 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3621
3622 type = elf_section_data (reloc_sec)->this_hdr.sh_type;
3623 if (type != SHT_REL && type != SHT_RELA)
3624 return NULL;
3625
3626 /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3627 name = reloc_sec->name;
3628 if (strncmp (name, ".rel", 4) != 0)
3629 return NULL;
3630 name += 4;
3631 if (type == SHT_RELA && *name++ != 'a')
3632 return NULL;
3633
3634 abfd = reloc_sec->owner;
3635 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3636 return bed->get_reloc_section (abfd, name);
3637 }
3638
3639 /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
3640 too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
3641 in here too, while we're at it. */
3642
3643 static bfd_boolean
3644 assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3645 {
3646 struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
3647 asection *sec;
3648 unsigned int section_number;
3649 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
3650 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
3651 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
3652
3653 section_number = 1;
3654
3655 _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3656
3657 /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
3658 if (link_info == NULL || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
3659 {
3660 size_t reloc_count = 0;
3661
3662 /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
3663 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3664 {
3665 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3666
3667 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
3668 {
3669 if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
3670 {
3671 /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
3672 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
3673 abfd->section_count--;
3674 }
3675 else
3676 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3677 }
3678
3679 /* Count relocations. */
3680 reloc_count += sec->reloc_count;
3681 }
3682
3683 /* Clear HAS_RELOC if there are no relocations. */
3684 if (reloc_count == 0)
3685 abfd->flags &= ~HAS_RELOC;
3686 }
3687
3688 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3689 {
3690 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3691
3692 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
3693 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3694 if (d->this_hdr.sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3695 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
3696 if (d->rel.hdr)
3697 {
3698 d->rel.idx = section_number++;
3699 if (d->rel.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3700 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
3701 }
3702 else
3703 d->rel.idx = 0;
3704
3705 if (d->rela.hdr)
3706 {
3707 d->rela.idx = section_number++;
3708 if (d->rela.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3709 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
3710 }
3711 else
3712 d->rela.idx = 0;
3713 }
3714
3715 need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3716 || (link_info == NULL
3717 && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3718 == HAS_RELOC)));
3719 if (need_symtab)
3720 {
3721 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = section_number++;
3722 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
3723 if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
3724 {
3725 elf_section_list * entry;
3726
3727 BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) == NULL);
3728
3729 entry = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
3730 entry->ndx = section_number++;
3731 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
3732 entry->hdr.sh_name
3733 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3734 ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
3735 if (entry->hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3736 return FALSE;
3737 }
3738 elf_strtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3739 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
3740 }
3741
3742 elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3743 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
3744 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
3745
3746 if (section_number >= SHN_LORESERVE)
3747 {
3748 /* xgettext:c-format */
3749 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: too many sections: %u"),
3750 abfd, section_number);
3751 return FALSE;
3752 }
3753
3754 elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
3755 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
3756
3757 /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3758 indices. */
3759 i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, section_number,
3760 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
3761 if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3762 return FALSE;
3763
3764 i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3765 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3766 if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3767 {
3768 bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3769 return FALSE;
3770 }
3771
3772 elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3773
3774 i_shdrp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3775 if (need_symtab)
3776 {
3777 i_shdrp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3778 if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
3779 {
3780 elf_section_list * entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
3781 BFD_ASSERT (entry != NULL);
3782 i_shdrp[entry->ndx] = & entry->hdr;
3783 entry->hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3784 }
3785 i_shdrp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3786 t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
3787 }
3788
3789 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3790 {
3791 asection *s;
3792
3793 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3794
3795 i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3796 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3797 i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
3798 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3799 i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
3800
3801 /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3802
3803 /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3804 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3805 the relocation entries apply. */
3806 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3807 {
3808 d->rel.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3809 d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3810 d->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3811 }
3812 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3813 {
3814 d->rela.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3815 d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3816 d->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3817 }
3818
3819 /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3820 if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3821 {
3822 s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3823 if (s)
3824 {
3825 /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section. */
3826 if (link_info != NULL)
3827 {
3828 /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3829 if (discarded_section (s))
3830 {
3831 asection *kept;
3832 _bfd_error_handler
3833 /* xgettext:c-format */
3834 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3835 " discarded section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3836 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
3837 s, s->owner);
3838 /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3839 size as the discarded one. */
3840 kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3841 if (kept == NULL)
3842 {
3843 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3844 return FALSE;
3845 }
3846 s = kept;
3847 }
3848
3849 s = s->output_section;
3850 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3851 }
3852 else
3853 {
3854 /* Handle objcopy. */
3855 if (s->output_section == NULL)
3856 {
3857 _bfd_error_handler
3858 /* xgettext:c-format */
3859 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3860 " removed section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3861 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3862 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3863 return FALSE;
3864 }
3865 s = s->output_section;
3866 }
3867 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3868 }
3869 else
3870 {
3871 /* PR 290:
3872 The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
3873 SHF_LINK_ORDER. But it doesn't set the sh_link or
3874 sh_info fields. Hence we could get the situation
3875 where s is NULL. */
3876 const struct elf_backend_data *bed
3877 = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3878 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
3879 bed->link_order_error_handler
3880 /* xgettext:c-format */
3881 (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
3882 abfd, sec);
3883 }
3884 }
3885
3886 switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3887 {
3888 case SHT_REL:
3889 case SHT_RELA:
3890 /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3891 section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3892 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3893 which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3894 allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3895 FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3896 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3897 if (s != NULL)
3898 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3899
3900 s = elf_get_reloc_section (sec);
3901 if (s != NULL)
3902 {
3903 d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3904 d->this_hdr.sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3905 }
3906 break;
3907
3908 case SHT_STRTAB:
3909 /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3910 string section. We look for a section with the same name
3911 but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3912 field to point to this section. */
3913 if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
3914 && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3915 {
3916 size_t len;
3917 char *alc;
3918
3919 len = strlen (sec->name);
3920 alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3921 if (alc == NULL)
3922 return FALSE;
3923 memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3924 alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3925 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3926 free (alc);
3927 if (s != NULL)
3928 {
3929 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3930
3931 /* This is a .stab section. */
3932 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
3933 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
3934 = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
3935 }
3936 }
3937 break;
3938
3939 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3940 case SHT_DYNSYM:
3941 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3942 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3943 /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3944 used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3945 version strings. */
3946 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
3947 if (s != NULL)
3948 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3949 break;
3950
3951 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
3952 /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
3953 list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
3954 the version strings. */
3955 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
3956 ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
3957 if (s != NULL)
3958 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3959 break;
3960
3961 case SHT_HASH:
3962 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3963 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3964 /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
3965 this hash table or version table is for. */
3966 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3967 if (s != NULL)
3968 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3969 break;
3970
3971 case SHT_GROUP:
3972 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3973 }
3974 }
3975
3976 /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
3977 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
3978 debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed. */
3979
3980 return TRUE;
3981 }
3982
3983 static bfd_boolean
3984 sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3985 {
3986 /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
3987 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3988 if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
3989 return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
3990
3991 return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
3992 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (sym))
3993 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (sym)));
3994 }
3995
3996 /* Filter global symbols of ABFD to include in the import library. All
3997 SYMCOUNT symbols of ABFD can be examined from their pointers in
3998 SYMS. Pointers of symbols to keep should be stored contiguously at
3999 the beginning of that array.
4000
4001 Returns the number of symbols to keep. */
4002
4003 unsigned int
4004 _bfd_elf_filter_global_symbols (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4005 asymbol **syms, long symcount)
4006 {
4007 long src_count, dst_count = 0;
4008
4009 for (src_count = 0; src_count < symcount; src_count++)
4010 {
4011 asymbol *sym = syms[src_count];
4012 char *name = (char *) bfd_asymbol_name (sym);
4013 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
4014
4015 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4016 continue;
4017
4018 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, name, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
4019 if (h == NULL)
4020 continue;
4021 if (h->type != bfd_link_hash_defined && h->type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4022 continue;
4023 if (h->linker_def || h->ldscript_def)
4024 continue;
4025
4026 syms[dst_count++] = sym;
4027 }
4028
4029 syms[dst_count] = NULL;
4030
4031 return dst_count;
4032 }
4033
4034 /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
4035 output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section. */
4036
4037 static bfd_boolean
4038 ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
4039 {
4040 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
4041
4042 if (sym == NULL)
4043 return FALSE;
4044
4045 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
4046 return FALSE;
4047
4048 if (sym->section == NULL)
4049 return TRUE;
4050
4051 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, sym);
4052 return ((type_ptr != NULL
4053 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
4054 && bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4055 || !(sym->section->owner == abfd
4056 || (sym->section->output_section != NULL
4057 && sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
4058 && sym->section->output_offset == 0)
4059 || bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section)));
4060 }
4061
4062 /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
4063 all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
4064
4065 static bfd_boolean
4066 elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd, unsigned int *pnum_locals)
4067 {
4068 unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
4069 asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
4070 asymbol **sect_syms;
4071 unsigned int num_locals = 0;
4072 unsigned int num_globals = 0;
4073 unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
4074 unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
4075 unsigned int max_index = 0;
4076 unsigned int idx;
4077 asection *asect;
4078 asymbol **new_syms;
4079
4080 #ifdef DEBUG
4081 fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
4082 fflush (stderr);
4083 #endif
4084
4085 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4086 {
4087 if (max_index < asect->index)
4088 max_index = asect->index;
4089 }
4090
4091 max_index++;
4092 sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, max_index, sizeof (asymbol *));
4093 if (sect_syms == NULL)
4094 return FALSE;
4095 elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
4096 elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
4097
4098 /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
4099 decided to output. */
4100 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4101 {
4102 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4103
4104 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
4105 && sym->value == 0
4106 && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
4107 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4108 {
4109 asection *sec = sym->section;
4110
4111 if (sec->owner != abfd)
4112 sec = sec->output_section;
4113
4114 sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
4115 }
4116 }
4117
4118 /* Classify all of the symbols. */
4119 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4120 {
4121 if (sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
4122 num_globals++;
4123 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
4124 num_locals++;
4125 }
4126
4127 /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
4128 sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
4129 eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
4130 at least in that case. */
4131 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4132 {
4133 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4134 {
4135 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
4136 num_locals++;
4137 else
4138 num_globals++;
4139 }
4140 }
4141
4142 /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
4143 new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_locals + num_globals,
4144 sizeof (asymbol *));
4145
4146 if (new_syms == NULL)
4147 return FALSE;
4148
4149 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4150 {
4151 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4152 unsigned int i;
4153
4154 if (sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4155 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4156 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
4157 i = num_locals2++;
4158 else
4159 continue;
4160 new_syms[i] = sym;
4161 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4162 }
4163 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4164 {
4165 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4166 {
4167 asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
4168 unsigned int i;
4169
4170 sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
4171 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4172 i = num_locals2++;
4173 else
4174 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4175 new_syms[i] = sym;
4176 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4177 }
4178 }
4179
4180 bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
4181
4182 *pnum_locals = num_locals;
4183 return TRUE;
4184 }
4185
4186 /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
4187 ELF data structure. */
4188
4189 static inline file_ptr
4190 align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
4191 {
4192 return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
4193 }
4194
4195 /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
4196 required section alignment. */
4197
4198 file_ptr
4199 _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
4200 file_ptr offset,
4201 bfd_boolean align)
4202 {
4203 if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
4204 offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
4205 i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
4206 if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
4207 i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
4208 if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4209 offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
4210 return offset;
4211 }
4212
4213 /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
4214 otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
4215 is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
4216
4217 bfd_boolean
4218 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
4219 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4220 {
4221 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4222 struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
4223 bfd_boolean failed;
4224 struct elf_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
4225 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
4226 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
4227
4228 if (abfd->output_has_begun)
4229 return TRUE;
4230
4231 /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
4232 if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
4233 (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
4234
4235 if (! prep_headers (abfd))
4236 return FALSE;
4237
4238 /* Post process the headers if necessary. */
4239 (*bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers) (abfd, link_info);
4240
4241 fsargs.failed = FALSE;
4242 fsargs.link_info = link_info;
4243 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
4244 if (fsargs.failed)
4245 return FALSE;
4246
4247 if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
4248 return FALSE;
4249
4250 /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
4251 need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
4252 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
4253 || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
4254 == HAS_RELOC)));
4255 if (need_symtab)
4256 {
4257 /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
4258 int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
4259
4260 if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
4261 return FALSE;
4262 }
4263
4264 failed = FALSE;
4265 if (link_info == NULL)
4266 {
4267 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
4268 if (failed)
4269 return FALSE;
4270 }
4271
4272 shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
4273 /* sh_name was set in prep_headers. */
4274 shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
4275 shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
4276 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
4277 /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4278 shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
4279 shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
4280 shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
4281 /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4282 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
4283
4284 if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
4285 return FALSE;
4286
4287 if (need_symtab)
4288 {
4289 file_ptr off;
4290 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4291
4292 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
4293
4294 hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
4295 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4296
4297 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL)
4298 {
4299 hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
4300 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
4301 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4302 /* FIXME: What about other symtab_shndx sections in the list ? */
4303 }
4304
4305 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
4306 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4307
4308 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
4309
4310 /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
4311 out. */
4312 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
4313 || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
4314 return FALSE;
4315 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab);
4316 }
4317
4318 abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
4319
4320 return TRUE;
4321 }
4322
4323 /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
4324 get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
4325
4326 static bfd_size_type
4327 get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4328 {
4329 size_t segs;
4330 asection *s;
4331 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4332
4333 /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
4334 and one for data. */
4335 segs = 2;
4336
4337 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4338 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4339 {
4340 /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
4341 PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
4342 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
4343 targets. */
4344 segs += 2;
4345 }
4346
4347 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
4348 {
4349 /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4350 ++segs;
4351 }
4352
4353 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4354 {
4355 /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
4356 ++segs;
4357 }
4358
4359 if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd))
4360 {
4361 /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
4362 ++segs;
4363 }
4364
4365 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4366 {
4367 /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
4368 ++segs;
4369 }
4370
4371 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4372 {
4373 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4374 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4375 {
4376 /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
4377 ++segs;
4378 /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment
4379 for all adjacent loadable .note* sections.
4380 gABI requires that within a PT_NOTE segment
4381 (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
4382 each note is padded to a multiple of 4 size,
4383 so we check whether the sections are correctly
4384 aligned. */
4385 if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4386 while (s->next != NULL
4387 && s->next->alignment_power == 2
4388 && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4389 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->next->name, ".note"))
4390 s = s->next;
4391 }
4392 }
4393
4394 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4395 {
4396 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4397 {
4398 /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
4399 ++segs;
4400 break;
4401 }
4402 }
4403
4404 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4405
4406 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4407 {
4408 /* Add a PT_GNU_MBIND segment for each mbind section. */
4409 unsigned int page_align_power = bfd_log2 (bed->commonpagesize);
4410 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4411 if (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
4412 {
4413 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
4414 > PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM)
4415 {
4416 _bfd_error_handler
4417 /* xgettext:c-format */
4418 (_("%pB: GNU_MBIN section `%pA' has invalid sh_info field: %d"),
4419 abfd, s, elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
4420 continue;
4421 }
4422 /* Align mbind section to page size. */
4423 if (s->alignment_power < page_align_power)
4424 s->alignment_power = page_align_power;
4425 segs ++;
4426 }
4427 }
4428
4429 /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
4430 if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
4431 {
4432 int a;
4433
4434 a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
4435 if (a == -1)
4436 abort ();
4437 segs += a;
4438 }
4439
4440 return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4441 }
4442
4443 /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
4444
4445 Elf_Internal_Phdr *
4446 _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
4447 {
4448 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4449 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4450
4451 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4452 m != NULL;
4453 m = m->next, p++)
4454 {
4455 int i;
4456
4457 for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4458 if (m->sections[i] == section)
4459 return p;
4460 }
4461
4462 return NULL;
4463 }
4464
4465 /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
4466
4467 static struct elf_segment_map *
4468 make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
4469 asection **sections,
4470 unsigned int from,
4471 unsigned int to,
4472 bfd_boolean phdr)
4473 {
4474 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4475 unsigned int i;
4476 asection **hdrpp;
4477 bfd_size_type amt;
4478
4479 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4480 amt += (to - from - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4481 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4482 if (m == NULL)
4483 return NULL;
4484 m->next = NULL;
4485 m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
4486 for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
4487 m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
4488 m->count = to - from;
4489
4490 if (from == 0 && phdr)
4491 {
4492 /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
4493 m->includes_filehdr = 1;
4494 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4495 }
4496
4497 return m;
4498 }
4499
4500 /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
4501 on failure. */
4502
4503 struct elf_segment_map *
4504 _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
4505 {
4506 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4507
4508 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
4509 sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
4510 if (m == NULL)
4511 return NULL;
4512 m->next = NULL;
4513 m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
4514 m->count = 1;
4515 m->sections[0] = dynsec;
4516
4517 return m;
4518 }
4519
4520 /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
4521
4522 static bfd_boolean
4523 elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
4524 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4525 bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
4526 {
4527 struct elf_segment_map **m;
4528 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4529
4530 /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
4531 not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
4532 sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
4533 sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
4534 removed. */
4535 m = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
4536 while (*m)
4537 {
4538 unsigned int i, new_count;
4539
4540 for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
4541 {
4542 if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
4543 && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
4544 || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
4545 {
4546 (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
4547 new_count++;
4548 }
4549 }
4550 (*m)->count = new_count;
4551
4552 if (remove_empty_load
4553 && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD
4554 && (*m)->count == 0
4555 && !(*m)->includes_phdrs)
4556 *m = (*m)->next;
4557 else
4558 m = &(*m)->next;
4559 }
4560
4561 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4562 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
4563 {
4564 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
4565 return FALSE;
4566 }
4567
4568 return TRUE;
4569 }
4570
4571 #define IS_TBSS(s) \
4572 ((s->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) == SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4573
4574 /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
4575
4576 bfd_boolean
4577 _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4578 {
4579 unsigned int count;
4580 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4581 asection **sections = NULL;
4582 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4583 bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
4584
4585 no_user_phdrs = elf_seg_map (abfd) == NULL;
4586
4587 if (info != NULL)
4588 info->user_phdrs = !no_user_phdrs;
4589
4590 if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
4591 {
4592 asection *s;
4593 unsigned int i;
4594 struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
4595 struct elf_segment_map **pm;
4596 asection *last_hdr;
4597 bfd_vma last_size;
4598 unsigned int phdr_index;
4599 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
4600 asection **hdrpp;
4601 bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4602 bfd_boolean writable;
4603 bfd_boolean executable;
4604 int tls_count = 0;
4605 asection *first_tls = NULL;
4606 asection *first_mbind = NULL;
4607 asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
4608 bfd_size_type amt;
4609 bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0;
4610 bfd_boolean linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = FALSE;
4611
4612 /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
4613
4614 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd),
4615 sizeof (asection *));
4616 if (sections == NULL)
4617 goto error_return;
4618
4619 /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
4620 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
4621 being shifted. */
4622 addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
4623 addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
4624
4625 i = 0;
4626 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4627 {
4628 if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4629 {
4630 sections[i] = s;
4631 ++i;
4632 /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
4633 if (((s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
4634 wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask;
4635 }
4636 }
4637 BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
4638 count = i;
4639
4640 qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
4641
4642 /* Build the mapping. */
4643
4644 mfirst = NULL;
4645 pm = &mfirst;
4646
4647 /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
4648 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
4649 section. */
4650 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4651 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4652 {
4653 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4654 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4655 if (m == NULL)
4656 goto error_return;
4657 m->next = NULL;
4658 m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
4659 m->p_flags = PF_R;
4660 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4661 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4662 linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = TRUE;
4663 *pm = m;
4664 pm = &m->next;
4665
4666 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4667 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4668 if (m == NULL)
4669 goto error_return;
4670 m->next = NULL;
4671 m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
4672 m->count = 1;
4673 m->sections[0] = s;
4674
4675 *pm = m;
4676 pm = &m->next;
4677 }
4678
4679 /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
4680 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
4681 a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
4682 last_hdr = NULL;
4683 last_size = 0;
4684 phdr_index = 0;
4685 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4686 /* PR 17512: file: c8455299.
4687 Avoid divide-by-zero errors later on.
4688 FIXME: Should we abort if the maxpagesize is zero ? */
4689 if (maxpagesize == 0)
4690 maxpagesize = 1;
4691 writable = FALSE;
4692 executable = FALSE;
4693 dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
4694 if (dynsec != NULL
4695 && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
4696 dynsec = NULL;
4697
4698 /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
4699 is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
4700 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
4701 program headers we will need. */
4702 if (count > 0)
4703 {
4704 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
4705
4706 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4707 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
4708 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4709 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
4710 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size
4711 || ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) % maxpagesize
4712 < phdr_size % maxpagesize)
4713 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize) < wrap_to)
4714 {
4715 /* PR 20815: The ELF standard says that a PT_PHDR segment, if
4716 present, must be included as part of the memory image of the
4717 program. Ie it must be part of a PT_LOAD segment as well.
4718 If we have had to create our own PT_PHDR segment, but it is
4719 not going to be covered by the first PT_LOAD segment, then
4720 force the inclusion if we can... */
4721 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4722 && linker_created_pt_phdr_segment)
4723 phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4724 else
4725 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4726 }
4727 }
4728
4729 for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
4730 {
4731 asection *hdr;
4732 bfd_boolean new_segment;
4733
4734 hdr = *hdrpp;
4735
4736 /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
4737 segment. */
4738
4739 if (last_hdr == NULL)
4740 {
4741 /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
4742 one (we build the last one after this loop). */
4743 new_segment = FALSE;
4744 }
4745 else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
4746 {
4747 /* If this section has a different relation between the
4748 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
4749 segment. */
4750 new_segment = TRUE;
4751 }
4752 else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
4753 || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
4754 {
4755 /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
4756 the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
4757 new_segment = TRUE;
4758 }
4759 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4760 && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4761 == (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
4762 {
4763 /* If we are demand paged then we can't map two disk
4764 pages onto the same memory page. */
4765 new_segment = FALSE;
4766 }
4767 /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
4768 to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
4769 around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
4770 pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
4771 section can be included in the current segment. */
4772 else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4773 + maxpagesize > last_hdr->lma)
4774 && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4775 + maxpagesize <= hdr->lma))
4776 {
4777 /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
4778 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
4779 new_segment = TRUE;
4780 }
4781 else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
4782 && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0)
4783 {
4784 /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
4785 nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
4786 as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
4787 Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose. */
4788 new_segment = TRUE;
4789 }
4790 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4791 {
4792 /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
4793 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
4794 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
4795 new_segment = FALSE;
4796 }
4797 else if (info != NULL
4798 && info->separate_code
4799 && executable != ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0))
4800 {
4801 new_segment = TRUE;
4802 }
4803 else if (! writable
4804 && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4805 {
4806 /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
4807 segment. */
4808 new_segment = TRUE;
4809 }
4810 else
4811 {
4812 /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
4813 new_segment = FALSE;
4814 }
4815
4816 /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
4817 if (last_hdr != NULL
4818 && info != NULL
4819 && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
4820 new_segment
4821 = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
4822 last_hdr,
4823 new_segment);
4824
4825 if (! new_segment)
4826 {
4827 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4828 writable = TRUE;
4829 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4830 executable = TRUE;
4831 last_hdr = hdr;
4832 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4833 last_size = !IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0;
4834 continue;
4835 }
4836
4837 /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4838 header holding all the sections from phdr_index until hdr. */
4839
4840 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4841 if (m == NULL)
4842 goto error_return;
4843
4844 *pm = m;
4845 pm = &m->next;
4846
4847 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4848 writable = TRUE;
4849 else
4850 writable = FALSE;
4851
4852 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
4853 executable = FALSE;
4854 else
4855 executable = TRUE;
4856
4857 last_hdr = hdr;
4858 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4859 last_size = !IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0;
4860 phdr_index = i;
4861 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4862 }
4863
4864 /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
4865 for .tbss. */
4866 if (last_hdr != NULL
4867 && (i - phdr_index != 1
4868 || !IS_TBSS (last_hdr)))
4869 {
4870 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4871 if (m == NULL)
4872 goto error_return;
4873
4874 *pm = m;
4875 pm = &m->next;
4876 }
4877
4878 /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4879 if (dynsec != NULL)
4880 {
4881 m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
4882 if (m == NULL)
4883 goto error_return;
4884 *pm = m;
4885 pm = &m->next;
4886 }
4887
4888 /* For each batch of consecutive loadable .note sections,
4889 add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
4890 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
4891 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
4892 in the output file. FIXME: Using names for section types is
4893 bogus anyhow. */
4894 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4895 {
4896 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4897 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4898 {
4899 asection *s2;
4900
4901 count = 1;
4902 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4903 if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4904 for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
4905 {
4906 if (s2->next->alignment_power == 2
4907 && (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4908 && CONST_STRNEQ (s2->next->name, ".note")
4909 && align_power (s2->lma + s2->size, 2)
4910 == s2->next->lma)
4911 count++;
4912 else
4913 break;
4914 }
4915 amt += (count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4916 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4917 if (m == NULL)
4918 goto error_return;
4919 m->next = NULL;
4920 m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
4921 m->count = count;
4922 while (count > 1)
4923 {
4924 m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
4925 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4926 s = s->next;
4927 }
4928 m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
4929 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4930 *pm = m;
4931 pm = &m->next;
4932 }
4933 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4934 {
4935 if (! tls_count)
4936 first_tls = s;
4937 tls_count++;
4938 }
4939 if (first_mbind == NULL
4940 && (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0)
4941 first_mbind = s;
4942 }
4943
4944 /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
4945 if (tls_count > 0)
4946 {
4947 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4948 amt += (tls_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4949 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4950 if (m == NULL)
4951 goto error_return;
4952 m->next = NULL;
4953 m->p_type = PT_TLS;
4954 m->count = tls_count;
4955 /* Mandated PF_R. */
4956 m->p_flags = PF_R;
4957 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4958 s = first_tls;
4959 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned int) tls_count; ++i)
4960 {
4961 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)
4962 {
4963 _bfd_error_handler
4964 (_("%pB: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd);
4965 s = first_tls;
4966 i = 0;
4967 while (i < (unsigned int) tls_count)
4968 {
4969 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
4970 {
4971 _bfd_error_handler (_(" TLS: %pA"), s);
4972 i++;
4973 }
4974 else
4975 _bfd_error_handler (_(" non-TLS: %pA"), s);
4976 s = s->next;
4977 }
4978 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4979 goto error_return;
4980 }
4981 m->sections[i] = s;
4982 s = s->next;
4983 }
4984
4985 *pm = m;
4986 pm = &m->next;
4987 }
4988
4989 if (first_mbind && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4990 for (s = first_mbind; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4991 if ((elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0
4992 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
4993 <= PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM))
4994 {
4995 /* Mandated PF_R. */
4996 unsigned long p_flags = PF_R;
4997 if ((s->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4998 p_flags |= PF_W;
4999 if ((s->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
5000 p_flags |= PF_X;
5001
5002 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) + sizeof (asection *);
5003 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5004 if (m == NULL)
5005 goto error_return;
5006 m->next = NULL;
5007 m->p_type = (PT_GNU_MBIND_LO
5008 + elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
5009 m->count = 1;
5010 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5011 m->sections[0] = s;
5012 m->p_flags = p_flags;
5013
5014 *pm = m;
5015 pm = &m->next;
5016 }
5017
5018 /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
5019 segment. */
5020 eh_frame_hdr = elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd);
5021 if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
5022 && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
5023 {
5024 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5025 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5026 if (m == NULL)
5027 goto error_return;
5028 m->next = NULL;
5029 m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
5030 m->count = 1;
5031 m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
5032
5033 *pm = m;
5034 pm = &m->next;
5035 }
5036
5037 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
5038 {
5039 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5040 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5041 if (m == NULL)
5042 goto error_return;
5043 m->next = NULL;
5044 m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
5045 m->p_flags = elf_stack_flags (abfd);
5046 m->p_align = bed->stack_align;
5047 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5048 m->p_align_valid = m->p_align != 0;
5049 if (info->stacksize > 0)
5050 {
5051 m->p_size = info->stacksize;
5052 m->p_size_valid = 1;
5053 }
5054
5055 *pm = m;
5056 pm = &m->next;
5057 }
5058
5059 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
5060 {
5061 for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
5062 {
5063 if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD
5064 && m->count != 0
5065 && m->sections[0]->vma >= info->relro_start
5066 && m->sections[0]->vma < info->relro_end)
5067 {
5068 i = m->count;
5069 while (--i != (unsigned) -1)
5070 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5071 == (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5072 break;
5073
5074 if (i != (unsigned) -1)
5075 break;
5076 }
5077 }
5078
5079 /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
5080 if (m != NULL)
5081 {
5082 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5083 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5084 if (m == NULL)
5085 goto error_return;
5086 m->next = NULL;
5087 m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
5088 *pm = m;
5089 pm = &m->next;
5090 }
5091 }
5092
5093 free (sections);
5094 elf_seg_map (abfd) = mfirst;
5095 }
5096
5097 if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
5098 return FALSE;
5099
5100 for (count = 0, m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5101 ++count;
5102 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5103
5104 return TRUE;
5105
5106 error_return:
5107 if (sections != NULL)
5108 free (sections);
5109 return FALSE;
5110 }
5111
5112 /* Sort sections by address. */
5113
5114 static int
5115 elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
5116 {
5117 const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
5118 const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
5119 bfd_size_type size1, size2;
5120
5121 /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
5122 place the section into a segment. */
5123 if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
5124 return -1;
5125 else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
5126 return 1;
5127
5128 /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
5129 the same, and this will do nothing. */
5130 if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
5131 return -1;
5132 else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
5133 return 1;
5134
5135 /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
5136
5137 #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
5138
5139 if (TOEND (sec1))
5140 {
5141 if (TOEND (sec2))
5142 {
5143 /* If the indices are the same, do not return 0
5144 here, but continue to try the next comparison. */
5145 if (sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index != 0)
5146 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5147 }
5148 else
5149 return 1;
5150 }
5151 else if (TOEND (sec2))
5152 return -1;
5153
5154 #undef TOEND
5155
5156 /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
5157 before others at the same address. */
5158
5159 size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
5160 size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
5161
5162 if (size1 < size2)
5163 return -1;
5164 if (size1 > size2)
5165 return 1;
5166
5167 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5168 }
5169
5170 /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
5171
5172 We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
5173 not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
5174 negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
5175 are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
5176 larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
5177 which is wrong.
5178
5179 What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
5180 the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
5181 the page size.'' */
5182 /* In other words, something like:
5183
5184 vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
5185 off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
5186 if (vma_offset < off_offset)
5187 adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
5188 else
5189 adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
5190
5191 which can be collapsed into the expression below. */
5192
5193 static file_ptr
5194 vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
5195 {
5196 /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero. */
5197 if (maxpagesize == 0)
5198 maxpagesize = 1;
5199 return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
5200 }
5201
5202 static void
5203 print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
5204 {
5205 unsigned int j;
5206 const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
5207 char buf[32];
5208
5209 if (pt == NULL)
5210 {
5211 if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
5212 sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
5213 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
5214 else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
5215 sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
5216 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
5217 else
5218 snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
5219 (unsigned int) m->p_type);
5220 pt = buf;
5221 }
5222 fflush (stdout);
5223 fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
5224 for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
5225 fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
5226 putc ('\n',stderr);
5227 fflush (stderr);
5228 }
5229
5230 static bfd_boolean
5231 write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
5232 {
5233 void *buf;
5234 bfd_boolean ret;
5235
5236 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
5237 return FALSE;
5238 buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
5239 if (buf == NULL)
5240 return FALSE;
5241 ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
5242 free (buf);
5243 return ret;
5244 }
5245
5246 /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
5247 sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
5248 the file header. */
5249
5250 static bfd_boolean
5251 assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5252 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5253 {
5254 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5255 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5256 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5257 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5258 file_ptr off;
5259 bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
5260 unsigned int pt_load_count = 0;
5261 unsigned int alloc;
5262 unsigned int i, j;
5263 bfd_vma header_pad = 0;
5264
5265 if (link_info == NULL
5266 && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
5267 return FALSE;
5268
5269 alloc = 0;
5270 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5271 {
5272 ++alloc;
5273 if (m->header_size)
5274 header_pad = m->header_size;
5275 }
5276
5277 if (alloc)
5278 {
5279 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5280 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5281 }
5282 else
5283 {
5284 /* PR binutils/12467. */
5285 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
5286 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
5287 }
5288
5289 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
5290
5291 if (elf_program_header_size (abfd) == (bfd_size_type) -1)
5292 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5293 else
5294 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd)
5295 >= alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
5296
5297 if (alloc == 0)
5298 {
5299 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5300 return TRUE;
5301 }
5302
5303 /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
5304 see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
5305 that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
5306 The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
5307 elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
5308 layout.
5309 See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
5310 where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
5311 last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
5312 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd) % bed->s->sizeof_phdr
5313 == 0);
5314 phdrs = (Elf_Internal_Phdr *)
5315 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd,
5316 (elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr),
5317 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
5318 elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
5319 if (phdrs == NULL)
5320 return FALSE;
5321
5322 maxpagesize = 1;
5323 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5324 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
5325
5326 off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5327 off += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5328 if (header_pad < (bfd_vma) off)
5329 header_pad = 0;
5330 else
5331 header_pad -= off;
5332 off += header_pad;
5333
5334 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs, j = 0;
5335 m != NULL;
5336 m = m->next, p++, j++)
5337 {
5338 asection **secpp;
5339 bfd_vma off_adjust;
5340 bfd_boolean no_contents;
5341
5342 /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
5343 sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
5344 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
5345 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
5346 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
5347 if (m->count > 1
5348 && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
5349 && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
5350 qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
5351 elf_sort_sections);
5352
5353 /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
5354 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
5355 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
5356 that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
5357 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
5358 p->p_type = m->p_type;
5359 p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
5360
5361 if (m->count == 0)
5362 p->p_vaddr = 0;
5363 else
5364 p->p_vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
5365
5366 if (m->p_paddr_valid)
5367 p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
5368 else if (m->count == 0)
5369 p->p_paddr = 0;
5370 else
5371 p->p_paddr = m->sections[0]->lma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
5372
5373 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5374 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5375 {
5376 /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
5377 the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
5378 objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
5379 value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
5380 may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
5381 segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
5382 on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
5383 segment. */
5384 if (m->p_align_valid)
5385 maxpagesize = m->p_align;
5386
5387 p->p_align = maxpagesize;
5388 pt_load_count += 1;
5389 }
5390 else if (m->p_align_valid)
5391 p->p_align = m->p_align;
5392 else if (m->count == 0)
5393 p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
5394 else
5395 p->p_align = 0;
5396
5397 no_contents = FALSE;
5398 off_adjust = 0;
5399 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5400 && m->count > 0)
5401 {
5402 bfd_size_type align;
5403 unsigned int align_power = 0;
5404
5405 if (m->p_align_valid)
5406 align = p->p_align;
5407 else
5408 {
5409 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5410 {
5411 unsigned int secalign;
5412
5413 secalign = bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, *secpp);
5414 if (secalign > align_power)
5415 align_power = secalign;
5416 }
5417 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
5418 if (align < maxpagesize)
5419 align = maxpagesize;
5420 }
5421
5422 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5423 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
5424 /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
5425 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
5426 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
5427 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
5428
5429 /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
5430 sections. */
5431 no_contents = TRUE;
5432 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5433 if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
5434 {
5435 no_contents = FALSE;
5436 break;
5437 }
5438
5439 off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align);
5440
5441 /* Broken hardware and/or kernel require that files do not
5442 map the same page with different permissions on some hppa
5443 processors. */
5444 if (pt_load_count > 1
5445 && bed->no_page_alias
5446 && (off & (maxpagesize - 1)) != 0
5447 && (off & -maxpagesize) == ((off + off_adjust) & -maxpagesize))
5448 off_adjust += maxpagesize;
5449 off += off_adjust;
5450 if (no_contents)
5451 {
5452 /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
5453 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
5454 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
5455 checks it. So to comply with the alignment
5456 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
5457 p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
5458 subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
5459 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
5460 }
5461 else
5462 off_adjust = 0;
5463 }
5464 /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
5465 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
5466 else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
5467 && m->count > 1
5468 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
5469 {
5470 _bfd_error_handler
5471 (_("%pB: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment"
5472 " is not the .dynamic section"),
5473 abfd);
5474 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5475 return FALSE;
5476 }
5477 /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
5478 else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
5479 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5480 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
5481
5482 p->p_offset = 0;
5483 p->p_filesz = 0;
5484 p->p_memsz = 0;
5485
5486 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5487 {
5488 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5489 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5490 p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5491 p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5492 if (m->count > 0)
5493 {
5494 if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off
5495 || (!m->p_paddr_valid
5496 && p->p_paddr < (bfd_vma) off))
5497 {
5498 _bfd_error_handler
5499 (_("%pB: not enough room for program headers,"
5500 " try linking with -N"),
5501 abfd);
5502 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5503 return FALSE;
5504 }
5505
5506 p->p_vaddr -= off;
5507 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5508 p->p_paddr -= off;
5509 }
5510 }
5511
5512 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5513 {
5514 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5515 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5516
5517 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5518 {
5519 p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5520
5521 if (m->count > 0)
5522 {
5523 p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5524 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5525 p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5526 }
5527 }
5528
5529 p->p_filesz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5530 p->p_memsz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5531 if (m->count)
5532 {
5533 p->p_filesz += header_pad;
5534 p->p_memsz += header_pad;
5535 }
5536 }
5537
5538 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5539 || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
5540 {
5541 if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
5542 p->p_offset = off;
5543 else
5544 {
5545 file_ptr adjust;
5546
5547 adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
5548 if (!no_contents)
5549 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5550 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5551 }
5552 }
5553
5554 /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
5555 maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
5556 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
5557 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
5558 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
5559 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5560 {
5561 asection *sec;
5562 bfd_size_type align;
5563 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5564
5565 sec = *secpp;
5566 this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
5567 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, sec);
5568
5569 if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5570 || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5571 && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
5572 || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
5573 && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
5574 || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
5575 {
5576 bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr;
5577 bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz;
5578 bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma;
5579 bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end;
5580
5581 if (adjust != 0
5582 && (s_start < p_end
5583 || p_end < p_start))
5584 {
5585 _bfd_error_handler
5586 /* xgettext:c-format */
5587 (_("%pB: section %pA lma %#" PRIx64 " adjusted to %#" PRIx64),
5588 abfd, sec, (uint64_t) s_start, (uint64_t) p_end);
5589 adjust = 0;
5590 sec->lma = p_end;
5591 }
5592 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5593
5594 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5595 {
5596 if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
5597 {
5598 /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
5599 Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
5600 zero it. */
5601 adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
5602 if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
5603 return FALSE;
5604 }
5605 off += adjust;
5606 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5607 }
5608 }
5609
5610 if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5611 {
5612 /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
5613 everything. */
5614 if (i == 0)
5615 {
5616 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5617 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5618 p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
5619 p->p_memsz = 0;
5620 p->p_align = 1;
5621 }
5622 else
5623 {
5624 /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
5625 sec->filepos = 0;
5626 sec->size = 0;
5627 sec->flags = 0;
5628 continue;
5629 }
5630 }
5631 else
5632 {
5633 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5634 {
5635 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5636 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5637 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5638 }
5639 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5640 && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
5641 && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
5642 {
5643 /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
5644 (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
5645 final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
5646 would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
5647 p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
5648 also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
5649 p_offset value. */
5650 bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
5651 off, align);
5652 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
5653 }
5654
5655 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5656 {
5657 p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5658 /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
5659 a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
5660 file space but are not loaded into memory. */
5661 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5662 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5663 }
5664 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5665 {
5666 if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5667 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5668
5669 /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
5670 normal segments. */
5671 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
5672 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5673 }
5674
5675 if (align > p->p_align
5676 && !m->p_align_valid
5677 && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5678 || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
5679 p->p_align = align;
5680 }
5681
5682 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5683 {
5684 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5685 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
5686 p->p_flags |= PF_X;
5687 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
5688 p->p_flags |= PF_W;
5689 }
5690 }
5691
5692 off -= off_adjust;
5693
5694 /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
5695 Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
5696 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5697 {
5698 bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
5699
5700 for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
5701 if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
5702 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
5703 ->this_hdr), p) != 0
5704 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
5705 ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
5706 {
5707 /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
5708 check_vma = FALSE;
5709 break;
5710 }
5711
5712 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5713 {
5714 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5715 asection *sec;
5716
5717 sec = m->sections[i];
5718 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
5719 if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
5720 && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
5721 {
5722 _bfd_error_handler
5723 /* xgettext:c-format */
5724 (_("%pB: section `%pA' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
5725 abfd, sec, j);
5726 print_segment_map (m);
5727 }
5728 }
5729 }
5730 }
5731
5732 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5733 return TRUE;
5734 }
5735
5736 /* Assign file positions for the other sections. */
5737
5738 static bfd_boolean
5739 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5740 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5741 {
5742 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5743 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
5744 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp, **end_hdrpp;
5745 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5746 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5747 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5748 struct elf_segment_map *hdrs_segment;
5749 bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr, filehdr_paddr;
5750 bfd_vma phdrs_vaddr, phdrs_paddr;
5751 file_ptr off;
5752 unsigned int count;
5753
5754 i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5755 end_hdrpp = i_shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
5756 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
5757 for (hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; hdrpp < end_hdrpp; hdrpp++)
5758 {
5759 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
5760
5761 hdr = *hdrpp;
5762 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5763 && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
5764 || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5765 && hdr->contents == NULL)))
5766 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
5767 else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5768 {
5769 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
5770 _bfd_error_handler
5771 /* xgettext:c-format */
5772 (_("%pB: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
5773 abfd,
5774 (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
5775 ? "*unknown*"
5776 : hdr->bfd_section->name));
5777 /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
5778 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
5779 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5780 bed->maxpagesize);
5781 else
5782 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5783 hdr->sh_addralign);
5784 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
5785 FALSE);
5786 }
5787 else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5788 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
5789 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5790 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
5791 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
5792 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]
5793 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
5794 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
5795 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)]
5796 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)])
5797 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
5798 else
5799 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
5800 }
5801
5802 /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
5803 the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
5804 count = 0;
5805 filehdr_vaddr = 0;
5806 filehdr_paddr = 0;
5807 phdrs_vaddr = bed->maxpagesize + bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5808 phdrs_paddr = 0;
5809 hdrs_segment = NULL;
5810 phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
5811 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5812 {
5813 ++count;
5814 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5815 continue;
5816
5817 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5818 {
5819 filehdr_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5820 filehdr_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5821 }
5822 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5823 {
5824 phdrs_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5825 phdrs_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5826 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5827 {
5828 hdrs_segment = m;
5829 phdrs_vaddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5830 phdrs_paddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5831 }
5832 }
5833 }
5834
5835 if (hdrs_segment != NULL && link_info != NULL)
5836 {
5837 /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
5838 program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
5839 A program can use this to examine itself robustly. */
5840
5841 struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash
5842 = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info), "__ehdr_start",
5843 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
5844 /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it. */
5845 if (hash != NULL
5846 && (hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
5847 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5848 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5849 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common))
5850 {
5851 asection *s = NULL;
5852 if (hdrs_segment->count != 0)
5853 /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one. */
5854 s = hdrs_segment->sections[0];
5855 else
5856 /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment. */
5857 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5858 if (m->count != 0)
5859 {
5860 s = m->sections[0];
5861 break;
5862 }
5863
5864 if (s != NULL)
5865 {
5866 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr - s->vma;
5867 hash->root.u.def.section = s;
5868 }
5869 else
5870 {
5871 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr;
5872 hash->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
5873 }
5874
5875 hash->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5876 hash->def_regular = 1;
5877 hash->non_elf = 0;
5878 }
5879 }
5880
5881 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5882 {
5883 if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
5884 {
5885 bfd_vma start, end;
5886 bfd_boolean ok;
5887
5888 if (link_info != NULL)
5889 {
5890 /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
5891 in link_info. Note that there may be padding between
5892 relro_start and the first RELRO section. */
5893 start = link_info->relro_start;
5894 end = link_info->relro_end;
5895 }
5896 else if (m->count != 0)
5897 {
5898 if (!m->p_size_valid)
5899 abort ();
5900 start = m->sections[0]->vma;
5901 end = start + m->p_size;
5902 }
5903 else
5904 {
5905 start = 0;
5906 end = 0;
5907 }
5908
5909 ok = FALSE;
5910 if (start < end)
5911 {
5912 struct elf_segment_map *lm;
5913 const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
5914 unsigned int i;
5915
5916 /* Find a LOAD segment containing a section in the RELRO
5917 segment. */
5918 for (lm = elf_seg_map (abfd), lp = phdrs;
5919 lm != NULL;
5920 lm = lm->next, lp++)
5921 {
5922 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
5923 && lm->count != 0
5924 && (lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->vma
5925 + (!IS_TBSS (lm->sections[lm->count - 1])
5926 ? lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->size
5927 : 0)) > start
5928 && lm->sections[0]->vma < end)
5929 break;
5930 }
5931
5932 if (lm != NULL)
5933 {
5934 /* Find the section starting the RELRO segment. */
5935 for (i = 0; i < lm->count; i++)
5936 {
5937 asection *s = lm->sections[i];
5938 if (s->vma >= start
5939 && s->vma < end
5940 && s->size != 0)
5941 break;
5942 }
5943
5944 if (i < lm->count)
5945 {
5946 p->p_vaddr = lm->sections[i]->vma;
5947 p->p_paddr = lm->sections[i]->lma;
5948 p->p_offset = lm->sections[i]->filepos;
5949 p->p_memsz = end - p->p_vaddr;
5950 p->p_filesz = p->p_memsz;
5951
5952 /* The RELRO segment typically ends a few bytes
5953 into .got.plt but other layouts are possible.
5954 In cases where the end does not match any
5955 loaded section (for instance is in file
5956 padding), trim p_filesz back to correspond to
5957 the end of loaded section contents. */
5958 if (p->p_filesz > lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr)
5959 p->p_filesz = lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr;
5960
5961 /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are
5962 valid. The gold linker generates RW/4 for
5963 the PT_GNU_RELRO section. It is better for
5964 objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
5965 otherwise gdb will choke when using separate
5966 debug files. */
5967 if (!m->p_align_valid)
5968 p->p_align = 1;
5969 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5970 p->p_flags = PF_R;
5971 ok = TRUE;
5972 }
5973 }
5974 }
5975 if (link_info != NULL)
5976 BFD_ASSERT (ok);
5977 if (!ok)
5978 memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
5979 }
5980 else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
5981 {
5982 if (m->p_size_valid)
5983 p->p_memsz = m->p_size;
5984 }
5985 else if (m->count != 0)
5986 {
5987 unsigned int i;
5988
5989 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5990 && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
5991 || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
5992 {
5993 /* A user specified segment layout may include a PHDR
5994 segment that overlaps with a LOAD segment... */
5995 if (p->p_type == PT_PHDR)
5996 {
5997 m->count = 0;
5998 continue;
5999 }
6000
6001 if (m->includes_filehdr || m->includes_phdrs)
6002 {
6003 /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e. */
6004 _bfd_error_handler
6005 (_("%pB: error: non-load segment %d includes file header "
6006 "and/or program header"),
6007 abfd, (int) (p - phdrs));
6008 return FALSE;
6009 }
6010
6011 p->p_filesz = 0;
6012 p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
6013 for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
6014 {
6015 asection *sect = m->sections[i];
6016 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
6017 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
6018 {
6019 p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
6020 + hdr->sh_size);
6021 break;
6022 }
6023 }
6024 }
6025 }
6026 else if (m->includes_filehdr)
6027 {
6028 p->p_vaddr = filehdr_vaddr;
6029 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
6030 p->p_paddr = filehdr_paddr;
6031 }
6032 else if (m->includes_phdrs)
6033 {
6034 p->p_vaddr = phdrs_vaddr;
6035 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
6036 p->p_paddr = phdrs_paddr;
6037 }
6038 }
6039
6040 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6041
6042 return TRUE;
6043 }
6044
6045 static elf_section_list *
6046 find_section_in_list (unsigned int i, elf_section_list * list)
6047 {
6048 for (;list != NULL; list = list->next)
6049 if (list->ndx == i)
6050 break;
6051 return list;
6052 }
6053
6054 /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
6055 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
6056 VMAs must be known before this is called.
6057
6058 Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
6059 "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and
6060 those that bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are
6061 stored in a normal bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't
6062 consider the former sort here, unless they form part of the loadable
6063 image. Reloc sections not assigned here will be handled later by
6064 assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
6065
6066 We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
6067
6068 static bfd_boolean
6069 assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
6070 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6071 {
6072 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
6073 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6074 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6075
6076 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
6077 && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
6078 {
6079 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6080 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6081 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
6082 unsigned int i;
6083 file_ptr off;
6084
6085 /* Start after the ELF header. */
6086 off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
6087
6088 /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
6089 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
6090 the sections in the file is unimportant. */
6091 for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
6092 {
6093 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6094
6095 hdr = *hdrpp;
6096 if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
6097 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
6098 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6099 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
6100 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6101 || i == elf_onesymtab (abfd)
6102 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
6103 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
6104 || i == elf_strtab_sec (abfd)
6105 || i == elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd))
6106 {
6107 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
6108 }
6109 else
6110 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
6111 }
6112
6113 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6114 }
6115 else
6116 {
6117 unsigned int alloc;
6118
6119 /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
6120 assignment of sections to segments. */
6121 if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6122 return FALSE;
6123
6124 /* And for non-load sections. */
6125 if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6126 return FALSE;
6127
6128 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers != NULL)
6129 {
6130 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers) (abfd, link_info))
6131 return FALSE;
6132 }
6133
6134 /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=. */
6135 if (link_info != NULL && bfd_link_pie (link_info))
6136 {
6137 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
6138 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
6139 Elf_Internal_Phdr *end_segment = &segment[num_segments];
6140
6141 /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments. */
6142 bfd_vma p_vaddr = (bfd_vma) -1;
6143 for (; segment < end_segment; segment++)
6144 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && p_vaddr > segment->p_vaddr)
6145 p_vaddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6146
6147 /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
6148 segments is non-zero. */
6149 if (p_vaddr)
6150 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6151 }
6152
6153 /* Write out the program headers. */
6154 alloc = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
6155 if (alloc == 0)
6156 return TRUE;
6157
6158 /* PR ld/20815 - Check that the program header segment, if present, will
6159 be loaded into memory. FIXME: The check below is not sufficient as
6160 really all PT_LOAD segments should be checked before issuing an error
6161 message. Plus the PHDR segment does not have to be the first segment
6162 in the program header table. But this version of the check should
6163 catch all real world use cases.
6164
6165 FIXME: We used to have code here to sort the PT_LOAD segments into
6166 ascending order, as per the ELF spec. But this breaks some programs,
6167 including the Linux kernel. But really either the spec should be
6168 changed or the programs updated. */
6169 if (alloc > 1
6170 && tdata->phdr[0].p_type == PT_PHDR
6171 && (bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr == NULL
6172 || !bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr (abfd, tdata->phdr,
6173 alloc))
6174 && tdata->phdr[1].p_type == PT_LOAD
6175 && (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr > tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr
6176 || (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[1].p_memsz
6177 < tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[0].p_memsz)))
6178 {
6179 /* The fix for this error is usually to edit the linker script being
6180 used and set up the program headers manually. Either that or
6181 leave room for the headers at the start of the SECTIONS. */
6182 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: error: PHDR segment not covered"
6183 " by LOAD segment"),
6184 abfd);
6185 return FALSE;
6186 }
6187
6188 if (bfd_seek (abfd, (bfd_signed_vma) bed->s->sizeof_ehdr, SEEK_SET) != 0
6189 || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
6190 return FALSE;
6191 }
6192
6193 return TRUE;
6194 }
6195
6196 static bfd_boolean
6197 prep_headers (bfd *abfd)
6198 {
6199 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
6200 struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
6201 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6202
6203 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6204
6205 shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
6206 if (shstrtab == NULL)
6207 return FALSE;
6208
6209 elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
6210
6211 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
6212 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
6213 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
6214 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
6215
6216 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
6217 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
6218 bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
6219 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
6220
6221 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
6222 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
6223 else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
6224 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6225 else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
6226 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
6227 else
6228 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
6229
6230 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
6231 {
6232 case bfd_arch_unknown:
6233 i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
6234 break;
6235
6236 /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
6237 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
6238 in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
6239 the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
6240 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
6241 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
6242 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
6243 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
6244 default:
6245 i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
6246 }
6247
6248 i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
6249 i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
6250
6251 /* No program header, for now. */
6252 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6253 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6254 i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
6255
6256 /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
6257 i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
6258 i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
6259
6260 /* If we're building an executable, we'll need a program header table. */
6261 if (abfd->flags & EXEC_P)
6262 /* It all happens later. */
6263 ;
6264 else
6265 {
6266 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6267 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6268 }
6269
6270 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
6271 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
6272 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
6273 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
6274 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
6275 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
6276 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6277 || elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6278 || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
6279 return FALSE;
6280
6281 return TRUE;
6282 }
6283
6284 /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
6285 of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers. */
6286
6287 static bfd_boolean
6288 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd *abfd)
6289 {
6290 file_ptr off;
6291 Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp, **end_shdrpp;
6292 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
6293 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
6294 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6295
6296 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
6297
6298 shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6299 end_shdrpp = shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
6300 for (shdrpp++; shdrpp < end_shdrpp; shdrpp++)
6301 {
6302 shdrp = *shdrpp;
6303 if (shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
6304 {
6305 asection *sec = shdrp->bfd_section;
6306 bfd_boolean is_rel = (shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL
6307 || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA);
6308 if (is_rel
6309 || (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS)))
6310 {
6311 if (!is_rel)
6312 {
6313 const char *name = sec->name;
6314 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
6315
6316 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6317 if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd, sec,
6318 shdrp->contents))
6319 return FALSE;
6320
6321 if (sec->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
6322 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) == 0)
6323 {
6324 /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
6325 section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*. */
6326 char *new_name
6327 = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
6328 if (new_name == NULL)
6329 return FALSE;
6330 name = new_name;
6331 }
6332 /* Add section name to section name section. */
6333 if (shdrp->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
6334 abort ();
6335 shdrp->sh_name
6336 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6337 name, FALSE);
6338 d = elf_section_data (sec);
6339
6340 /* Add reloc section name to section name section. */
6341 if (d->rel.hdr
6342 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6343 d->rel.hdr,
6344 name, FALSE))
6345 return FALSE;
6346 if (d->rela.hdr
6347 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6348 d->rela.hdr,
6349 name, TRUE))
6350 return FALSE;
6351
6352 /* Update section size and contents. */
6353 shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
6354 shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
6355 shdrp->bfd_section->contents = NULL;
6356 }
6357 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp,
6358 off,
6359 TRUE);
6360 }
6361 }
6362 }
6363
6364 /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
6365 compressed. */
6366 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6367 shdrp = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
6368 shdrp->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6369 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
6370
6371 /* Place the section headers. */
6372 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6373 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6374 off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
6375 i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
6376 off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
6377 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6378
6379 return TRUE;
6380 }
6381
6382 bfd_boolean
6383 _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
6384 {
6385 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6386 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
6387 bfd_boolean failed;
6388 unsigned int count, num_sec;
6389 struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
6390
6391 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
6392 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
6393 return FALSE;
6394
6395 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6396
6397 failed = FALSE;
6398 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
6399 if (failed)
6400 return FALSE;
6401
6402 if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd))
6403 return FALSE;
6404
6405 /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
6406 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6407 for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
6408 {
6409 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name
6410 = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6411 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name);
6412 if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
6413 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]))
6414 return FALSE;
6415 if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
6416 {
6417 bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
6418
6419 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6420 || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
6421 return FALSE;
6422 }
6423 }
6424
6425 /* Write out the section header names. */
6426 t = elf_tdata (abfd);
6427 if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
6428 && (bfd_seek (abfd, t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6429 || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
6430 return FALSE;
6431
6432 if (bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing)
6433 (*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd, elf_linker (abfd));
6434
6435 if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
6436 return FALSE;
6437
6438 /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
6439 if (t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents != NULL)
6440 return (*t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
6441
6442 return TRUE;
6443 }
6444
6445 bfd_boolean
6446 _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
6447 {
6448 /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
6449 return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
6450 }
6451
6452 /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
6453
6454 unsigned int
6455 _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
6456 {
6457 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6458 unsigned int sec_index;
6459
6460 if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
6461 && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
6462 return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
6463
6464 if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
6465 sec_index = SHN_ABS;
6466 else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
6467 sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
6468 else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
6469 sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
6470 else
6471 sec_index = SHN_BAD;
6472
6473 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6474 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
6475 {
6476 int retval = sec_index;
6477
6478 if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
6479 return retval;
6480 }
6481
6482 if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
6483 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
6484
6485 return sec_index;
6486 }
6487
6488 /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
6489 on error. */
6490
6491 int
6492 _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
6493 {
6494 asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
6495 int idx;
6496 flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
6497
6498 /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
6499 own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
6500 symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
6501 relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
6502 input sections rather than the output section. */
6503 if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
6504 && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6505 && asym_ptr->section)
6506 {
6507 asection *sec;
6508 int indx;
6509
6510 sec = asym_ptr->section;
6511 if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
6512 sec = sec->output_section;
6513 if (sec->owner == abfd
6514 && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
6515 && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
6516 asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
6517 }
6518
6519 idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
6520
6521 if (idx == 0)
6522 {
6523 /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
6524 which is used in a relocation entry. */
6525 _bfd_error_handler
6526 /* xgettext:c-format */
6527 (_("%pB: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
6528 abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
6529 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
6530 return -1;
6531 }
6532
6533 #if DEBUG & 4
6534 {
6535 fprintf (stderr,
6536 "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8x\n",
6537 (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, flags);
6538 fflush (stderr);
6539 }
6540 #endif
6541
6542 return idx;
6543 }
6544
6545 /* Rewrite program header information. */
6546
6547 static bfd_boolean
6548 rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6549 {
6550 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
6551 struct elf_segment_map *map;
6552 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
6553 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
6554 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6555 asection *section;
6556 unsigned int i;
6557 unsigned int num_segments;
6558 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
6559 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
6560 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
6561 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
6562 unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
6563 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6564
6565 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6566 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6567
6568 map_first = NULL;
6569 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6570
6571 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6572 maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
6573
6574 /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
6575 #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
6576 (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
6577 ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
6578
6579 #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
6580 (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6581 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
6582 ? section->size : 0)
6583
6584 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6585 the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
6586 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment) \
6587 (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr \
6588 && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6589 <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
6590
6591 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6592 the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
6593 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base) \
6594 (section->lma >= base \
6595 && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6596 <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
6597
6598 /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
6599 #define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
6600 (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
6601 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
6602 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6603 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6604 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6605
6606 /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
6607 etc. */
6608 #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
6609 (IS_NOTE (p, s) \
6610 && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
6611 && s->vma == 0 \
6612 && s->lma == 0)
6613
6614 /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
6615 linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
6616 p_memsz set to 0. */
6617 #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
6618 (p->p_vaddr == 0 \
6619 && p->p_paddr == 0 \
6620 && p->p_memsz == 0 \
6621 && p->p_filesz > 0 \
6622 && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
6623 && s->size > 0 \
6624 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6625 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6626 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6627
6628 /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
6629 A section will be included if:
6630 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
6631 if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
6632 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
6633 segment.
6634 3. There is an output section associated with it,
6635 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
6636 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
6637 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
6638 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
6639 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
6640 (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
6641 #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6642 ((((segment->p_paddr \
6643 ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr) \
6644 : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment)) \
6645 && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
6646 || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
6647 && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
6648 && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
6649 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6650 && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
6651 || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
6652 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
6653 && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
6654 || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
6655 || (segment->p_paddr \
6656 ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma \
6657 : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma) \
6658 || (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (ibfd, section), ".dynamic") \
6659 == 0)) \
6660 && (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD || !section->segment_mark))
6661
6662 /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
6663 it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6664 #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6665 (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed) \
6666 && section->output_section != NULL)
6667
6668 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
6669 #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
6670 (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
6671
6672 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
6673 their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
6674 It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
6675 ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
6676 to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
6677 LMA. */
6678 #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
6679 ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
6680 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
6681 && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
6682 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
6683
6684 /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
6685 for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
6686 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6687
6688 /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
6689 p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
6690 file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
6691 don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
6692 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6693 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6694 i < num_segments;
6695 i++, segment++)
6696 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6697 {
6698 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
6699 break;
6700 }
6701
6702 /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
6703 of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
6704 in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
6705 parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
6706 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6707 i < num_segments;
6708 i++, segment++)
6709 {
6710 unsigned int j;
6711 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
6712
6713 if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
6714 for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
6715 if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
6716 {
6717 /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
6718 assignment code will work. */
6719 segment->p_vaddr = section->vma;
6720 break;
6721 }
6722
6723 if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6724 {
6725 /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
6726 if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6727 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6728 continue;
6729 }
6730
6731 /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
6732 for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
6733 {
6734 bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
6735
6736 if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
6737 || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
6738 continue;
6739
6740 /* Merge the two segments together. */
6741 if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
6742 {
6743 /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
6744 SEGMENT. */
6745 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
6746 - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
6747
6748 if (extra_length > 0)
6749 {
6750 segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
6751 segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
6752 }
6753
6754 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6755
6756 /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
6757 i = 0;
6758 segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6759 break;
6760 }
6761 else
6762 {
6763 /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
6764 SEGMENT2. */
6765 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
6766 - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
6767
6768 if (extra_length > 0)
6769 {
6770 segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
6771 segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
6772 }
6773
6774 segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
6775 }
6776 }
6777 }
6778
6779 /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
6780 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6781 i < num_segments;
6782 i++, segment++)
6783 {
6784 unsigned int section_count;
6785 asection **sections;
6786 asection *output_section;
6787 unsigned int isec;
6788 asection *matching_lma;
6789 asection *suggested_lma;
6790 unsigned int j;
6791 bfd_size_type amt;
6792 asection *first_section;
6793
6794 if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
6795 continue;
6796
6797 first_section = NULL;
6798 /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
6799 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
6800 section != NULL;
6801 section = section->next)
6802 {
6803 /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
6804 removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6805 if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6806 {
6807 if (first_section == NULL)
6808 first_section = section;
6809 if (section->output_section != NULL)
6810 ++section_count;
6811 }
6812 }
6813
6814 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
6815 all of the sections we have selected. */
6816 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
6817 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
6818 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6819 if (map == NULL)
6820 return FALSE;
6821
6822 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
6823 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
6824 map->next = NULL;
6825 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6826 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6827 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6828
6829 /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
6830 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
6831 output segment. */
6832 if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
6833 {
6834 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
6835 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6836 }
6837
6838 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
6839 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
6840 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
6841 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
6842 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6843
6844 if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6845 {
6846 map->includes_phdrs =
6847 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6848 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
6849 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6850 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
6851
6852 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
6853 phdr_included = TRUE;
6854 }
6855
6856 if (section_count == 0)
6857 {
6858 /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
6859 no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
6860 something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
6861 a warning is produced.
6862 There is however the valid use case of embedded systems which
6863 have segments with p_filesz of 0 and a p_memsz > 0 to initialize
6864 flash memory with zeros. No warning is shown for that case. */
6865 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
6866 && (segment->p_filesz > 0 || segment->p_memsz == 0))
6867 /* xgettext:c-format */
6868 _bfd_error_handler
6869 (_("%pB: warning: empty loadable segment detected"
6870 " at vaddr=%#" PRIx64 ", is this intentional?"),
6871 ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_vaddr);
6872
6873 map->count = 0;
6874 *pointer_to_map = map;
6875 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6876
6877 continue;
6878 }
6879
6880 /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
6881 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
6882 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
6883 been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
6884
6885 1. None of the sections have been moved.
6886 In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
6887 input BFD.
6888
6889 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
6890 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6891 of the first section.
6892
6893 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
6894 In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
6895 placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
6896 and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
6897 have to be created to contain the other sections.
6898
6899 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
6900 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6901 of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
6902 or segments to contain the other sections.
6903
6904 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
6905 pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
6906 to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
6907
6908 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (section_count, sizeof (asection *));
6909 if (sections == NULL)
6910 return FALSE;
6911
6912 /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
6913 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
6914 Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
6915 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
6916 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
6917 more to do. */
6918 isec = 0;
6919 matching_lma = NULL;
6920 suggested_lma = NULL;
6921
6922 for (section = first_section, j = 0;
6923 section != NULL;
6924 section = section->next)
6925 {
6926 if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6927 {
6928 output_section = section->output_section;
6929
6930 sections[j++] = section;
6931
6932 /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
6933 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
6934 correct value. Note - some backends require that
6935 p_paddr be left as zero. */
6936 if (!p_paddr_valid
6937 && segment->p_vaddr != 0
6938 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6939 && isec == 0
6940 && output_section->lma != 0
6941 && (align_power (segment->p_vaddr
6942 + (map->includes_filehdr
6943 ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
6944 + (map->includes_phdrs
6945 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
6946 : 0),
6947 output_section->alignment_power)
6948 == output_section->vma))
6949 map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6950
6951 /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
6952 LMA address of the output section. */
6953 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
6954 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
6955 || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6956 && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment)))
6957 {
6958 if (matching_lma == NULL
6959 || output_section->lma < matching_lma->lma)
6960 matching_lma = output_section;
6961
6962 /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
6963 then it does not overlap any other section within that
6964 segment. */
6965 map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
6966 }
6967 else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
6968 suggested_lma = output_section;
6969
6970 if (j == section_count)
6971 break;
6972 }
6973 }
6974
6975 BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
6976
6977 /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
6978 if necessary. */
6979 if (isec == section_count)
6980 {
6981 /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
6982 specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
6983 the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
6984 program header in the input BFD. */
6985 map->count = section_count;
6986 *pointer_to_map = map;
6987 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6988
6989 if (p_paddr_valid
6990 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6991 && matching_lma->lma != map->p_paddr
6992 && !map->includes_filehdr
6993 && !map->includes_phdrs)
6994 /* There is some padding before the first section in the
6995 segment. So, we must account for that in the output
6996 segment's vma. */
6997 map->p_vaddr_offset = matching_lma->lma - map->p_paddr;
6998
6999 free (sections);
7000 continue;
7001 }
7002 else
7003 {
7004 /* Change the current segment's physical address to match
7005 the LMA of the first section that fitted, or if no
7006 section fitted, the first section. */
7007 if (matching_lma == NULL)
7008 matching_lma = suggested_lma;
7009
7010 map->p_paddr = matching_lma->lma;
7011
7012 /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
7013 to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
7014 if (map->includes_phdrs)
7015 {
7016 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7017
7018 /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
7019 of program headers that we will need. Make a note
7020 here of the number we used and the segment we chose
7021 to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
7022 offset when we know the correct value. */
7023 phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
7024 phdr_adjust_seg = map;
7025 }
7026
7027 if (map->includes_filehdr)
7028 {
7029 bfd_vma align = (bfd_vma) 1 << matching_lma->alignment_power;
7030 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
7031 /* We've subtracted off the size of headers from the
7032 first section lma, but there may have been some
7033 alignment padding before that section too. Try to
7034 account for that by adjusting the segment lma down to
7035 the same alignment. */
7036 if (segment->p_align != 0 && segment->p_align < align)
7037 align = segment->p_align;
7038 map->p_paddr &= -align;
7039 }
7040 }
7041
7042 /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
7043 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
7044 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
7045 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
7046 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
7047 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
7048 the loop. */
7049 isec = 0;
7050 do
7051 {
7052 map->count = 0;
7053 suggested_lma = NULL;
7054
7055 /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
7056 for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
7057 {
7058 section = sections[j];
7059
7060 if (section == NULL)
7061 continue;
7062
7063 output_section = section->output_section;
7064
7065 BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
7066
7067 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
7068 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
7069 {
7070 if (map->count == 0)
7071 {
7072 /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
7073 the beginning of the segment, then something is
7074 wrong. */
7075 if (align_power (map->p_paddr
7076 + (map->includes_filehdr
7077 ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
7078 + (map->includes_phdrs
7079 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
7080 : 0),
7081 output_section->alignment_power)
7082 != output_section->lma)
7083 abort ();
7084 }
7085 else
7086 {
7087 asection *prev_sec;
7088
7089 prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
7090
7091 /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
7092 and the start of this section is more than
7093 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
7094 if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
7095 maxpagesize)
7096 < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
7097 || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
7098 > output_section->lma))
7099 {
7100 if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7101 suggested_lma = output_section;
7102
7103 continue;
7104 }
7105 }
7106
7107 map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
7108 ++isec;
7109 sections[j] = NULL;
7110 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD)
7111 section->segment_mark = TRUE;
7112 }
7113 else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7114 suggested_lma = output_section;
7115 }
7116
7117 BFD_ASSERT (map->count > 0);
7118
7119 /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
7120 *pointer_to_map = map;
7121 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7122
7123 if (isec < section_count)
7124 {
7125 /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
7126 segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
7127 and carry on looping. */
7128 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
7129 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
7130 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7131 if (map == NULL)
7132 {
7133 free (sections);
7134 return FALSE;
7135 }
7136
7137 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
7138 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
7139 not yet been assigned. */
7140 map->next = NULL;
7141 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7142 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7143 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7144 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma->lma;
7145 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7146 map->includes_filehdr = 0;
7147 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7148 }
7149 }
7150 while (isec < section_count);
7151
7152 free (sections);
7153 }
7154
7155 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7156
7157 /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
7158 going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
7159 the offset if necessary. */
7160 if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
7161 {
7162 unsigned int count;
7163
7164 for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7165 count++;
7166
7167 if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
7168 phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
7169 -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7170
7171 for (map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7172 if (map->p_type == PT_PHDR)
7173 {
7174 bfd_vma adjust
7175 = phdr_adjust_seg->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0;
7176 map->p_paddr = phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr + adjust;
7177 break;
7178 }
7179 }
7180
7181 #undef SEGMENT_END
7182 #undef SECTION_SIZE
7183 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
7184 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
7185 #undef IS_NOTE
7186 #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
7187 #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
7188 #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
7189 #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
7190 #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
7191 #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
7192 return TRUE;
7193 }
7194
7195 /* Copy ELF program header information. */
7196
7197 static bfd_boolean
7198 copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7199 {
7200 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
7201 struct elf_segment_map *map;
7202 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
7203 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
7204 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7205 unsigned int i;
7206 unsigned int num_segments;
7207 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
7208 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
7209
7210 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
7211
7212 map_first = NULL;
7213 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
7214
7215 /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
7216 map->p_paddr_valid. */
7217 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7218 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7219 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7220 i < num_segments;
7221 i++, segment++)
7222 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
7223 {
7224 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
7225 break;
7226 }
7227
7228 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7229 i < num_segments;
7230 i++, segment++)
7231 {
7232 asection *section;
7233 unsigned int section_count;
7234 bfd_size_type amt;
7235 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7236 asection *first_section = NULL;
7237 asection *lowest_section;
7238 bfd_boolean no_contents = TRUE;
7239
7240 /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
7241 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
7242 section != NULL;
7243 section = section->next)
7244 {
7245 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7246 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7247 {
7248 if (first_section == NULL)
7249 first_section = section;
7250 if (elf_section_type (section) != SHT_NOBITS)
7251 no_contents = FALSE;
7252 section_count++;
7253 }
7254 }
7255
7256 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7257 all of the sections we have selected. */
7258 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
7259 if (section_count != 0)
7260 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
7261 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7262 if (map == NULL)
7263 return FALSE;
7264
7265 /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
7266 input segment. */
7267 map->next = NULL;
7268 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7269 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7270 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7271 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
7272 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7273 map->p_align = segment->p_align;
7274 map->p_align_valid = 1;
7275 map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
7276
7277 if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO
7278 || map->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
7279 {
7280 /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
7281 bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
7282 section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
7283 change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
7284 Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
7285 systems. */
7286 map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
7287 map->p_size_valid = 1;
7288 }
7289
7290 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7291 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7292 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
7293 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
7294
7295 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7296 if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
7297 {
7298 map->includes_phdrs =
7299 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7300 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
7301 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7302 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
7303
7304 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
7305 phdr_included = TRUE;
7306 }
7307
7308 lowest_section = NULL;
7309 if (section_count != 0)
7310 {
7311 unsigned int isec = 0;
7312
7313 for (section = first_section;
7314 section != NULL;
7315 section = section->next)
7316 {
7317 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7318 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7319 {
7320 map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
7321 if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7322 {
7323 bfd_vma seg_off;
7324
7325 if (lowest_section == NULL
7326 || section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
7327 lowest_section = section;
7328
7329 /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
7330 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
7331 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
7332 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
7333 invalid. */
7334 if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
7335 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
7336 else
7337 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
7338 if (section->lma - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
7339 map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7340 }
7341 if (isec == section_count)
7342 break;
7343 }
7344 }
7345 }
7346
7347 if (map->includes_filehdr && lowest_section != NULL)
7348 {
7349 /* Try to keep the space used by the headers plus any
7350 padding fixed. If there are sections with file contents
7351 in this segment then the lowest sh_offset is the best
7352 guess. Otherwise the segment only has file contents for
7353 the headers, and p_filesz is the best guess. */
7354 if (no_contents)
7355 map->header_size = segment->p_filesz;
7356 else
7357 map->header_size = lowest_section->filepos;
7358 }
7359
7360 if (!map->includes_phdrs
7361 && !map->includes_filehdr
7362 && map->p_paddr_valid)
7363 /* There is some other padding before the first section. */
7364 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0)
7365 - segment->p_paddr);
7366
7367 map->count = section_count;
7368 *pointer_to_map = map;
7369 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7370 }
7371
7372 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7373 return TRUE;
7374 }
7375
7376 /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
7377 information. */
7378
7379 static bfd_boolean
7380 copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7381 {
7382 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7383 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7384 return TRUE;
7385
7386 if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
7387 return TRUE;
7388
7389 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7390 {
7391 /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
7392 covered by ELF program header have changed. */
7393 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7394 asection *section, *osec;
7395 unsigned int i, num_segments;
7396 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7397 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7398
7399 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
7400
7401 /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
7402 if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
7403 goto rewrite;
7404
7405 /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
7406 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7407 section = section->next)
7408 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7409
7410 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7411 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7412 i < num_segments;
7413 i++, segment++)
7414 {
7415 /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
7416 and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
7417 which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
7418 map in this case. */
7419 if (segment->p_paddr == 0
7420 && segment->p_memsz == 0
7421 && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
7422 goto rewrite;
7423
7424 for (section = ibfd->sections;
7425 section != NULL; section = section->next)
7426 {
7427 /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
7428 from the input BFD. */
7429 osec = section->output_section;
7430 if (osec)
7431 osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
7432
7433 /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
7434 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7435 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7436 {
7437 /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
7438 removed. What else do we need to check? */
7439 if (osec == NULL
7440 || section->flags != osec->flags
7441 || section->lma != osec->lma
7442 || section->vma != osec->vma
7443 || section->size != osec->size
7444 || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
7445 || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
7446 goto rewrite;
7447 }
7448 }
7449 }
7450
7451 /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
7452 input BFD. */
7453 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7454 section = section->next)
7455 {
7456 if (!section->segment_mark)
7457 goto rewrite;
7458 else
7459 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7460 }
7461
7462 return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7463 }
7464
7465 rewrite:
7466 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7467 {
7468 /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
7469 the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments. */
7470 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7471 unsigned int i;
7472 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7473 bfd_vma maxpagesize = 0;
7474
7475 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7476 i < num_segments;
7477 i++, segment++)
7478 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
7479 && maxpagesize < segment->p_align)
7480 {
7481 /* PR 17512: file: f17299af. */
7482 if (segment->p_align > (bfd_vma) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 2))
7483 /* xgettext:c-format */
7484 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: warning: segment alignment of %#"
7485 PRIx64 " is too large"),
7486 ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_align);
7487 else
7488 maxpagesize = segment->p_align;
7489 }
7490
7491 if (maxpagesize != get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize)
7492 bfd_emul_set_maxpagesize (bfd_get_target (obfd), maxpagesize);
7493 }
7494
7495 return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7496 }
7497
7498 /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
7499
7500 bfd_boolean
7501 _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7502 asection *isec,
7503 bfd *obfd,
7504 asection *osec,
7505 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
7506
7507 {
7508 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7509 bfd_boolean final_link = (link_info != NULL
7510 && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info));
7511
7512 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7513 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7514 return TRUE;
7515
7516 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
7517
7518 /* For objcopy and relocatable link, don't copy the output ELF
7519 section type from input if the output BFD section flags have been
7520 set to something different. For a final link allow some flags
7521 that the linker clears to differ. */
7522 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
7523 && (osec->flags == isec->flags
7524 || (final_link
7525 && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
7526 & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
7527 elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
7528
7529 /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
7530 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7531 & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
7532
7533 /* Copy sh_info from input for mbind section. */
7534 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
7535 elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr.sh_info
7536 = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.sh_info;
7537
7538 /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
7539 SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
7540 to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
7541 See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
7542 if ((link_info == NULL
7543 || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
7544 && (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
7545 || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0))
7546 {
7547 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
7548 elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
7549 elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7550 elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
7551 }
7552
7553 /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED. */
7554 if (!final_link && (ibfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS) == 0)
7555 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7556 & SHF_COMPRESSED);
7557
7558 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7559
7560 /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
7561 don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
7562 may be NULL at this point. */
7563 if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
7564 {
7565 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7566 ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
7567 elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
7568 }
7569
7570 osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
7571
7572 return TRUE;
7573 }
7574
7575 /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
7576 field, and sometimes the info field. */
7577
7578 bfd_boolean
7579 _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7580 asection *isec,
7581 bfd *obfd,
7582 asection *osec)
7583 {
7584 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7585
7586 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7587 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7588 return TRUE;
7589
7590 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7591 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7592
7593 ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
7594
7595 if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
7596 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
7597 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
7598 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
7599 ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
7600
7601 return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
7602 NULL);
7603 }
7604
7605 /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
7606 necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
7607 the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
7608 output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
7609 function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
7610 from the linker. */
7611
7612 bfd_boolean
7613 _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
7614 {
7615 asection *isec;
7616
7617 for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
7618 if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
7619 {
7620 asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7621 asection *s = first;
7622 bfd_size_type removed = 0;
7623
7624 while (s != NULL)
7625 {
7626 /* If this member section is being output but the
7627 SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
7628 set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
7629 if (s->output_section != discarded
7630 && isec->output_section == discarded)
7631 {
7632 elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
7633 elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
7634 }
7635 /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
7636 but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size. */
7637 else if (s->output_section == discarded
7638 && isec->output_section != discarded)
7639 {
7640 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
7641 removed += 4;
7642 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
7643 && (elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7644 removed += 4;
7645 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
7646 && (elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7647 removed += 4;
7648 }
7649 s = elf_next_in_group (s);
7650 if (s == first)
7651 break;
7652 }
7653 if (removed != 0)
7654 {
7655 if (discarded != NULL)
7656 {
7657 /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
7658 adjust the input section size. */
7659 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
7660 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
7661 isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
7662 if (isec->size <= 4)
7663 {
7664 isec->size = 0;
7665 isec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7666 }
7667 }
7668 else
7669 {
7670 /* Adjust the output section size when called from
7671 objcopy. */
7672 isec->output_section->size -= removed;
7673 if (isec->output_section->size <= 4)
7674 {
7675 isec->output_section->size = 0;
7676 isec->output_section->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7677 }
7678 }
7679 }
7680 }
7681
7682 return TRUE;
7683 }
7684
7685 /* Copy private header information. */
7686
7687 bfd_boolean
7688 _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7689 {
7690 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7691 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7692 return TRUE;
7693
7694 /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
7695 This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
7696 entry point, because the latter is called after the section
7697 contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
7698 already been worked out. */
7699 if (elf_seg_map (obfd) == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
7700 {
7701 if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
7702 return FALSE;
7703 }
7704
7705 return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
7706 }
7707
7708 /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
7709 which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
7710 index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
7711 section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
7712 swap_out_syms function. */
7713
7714 #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
7715 #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
7716 #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
7717 #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
7718 #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
7719
7720 bfd_boolean
7721 _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
7722 asymbol *isymarg,
7723 bfd *obfd,
7724 asymbol *osymarg)
7725 {
7726 elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
7727
7728 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7729 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7730 return TRUE;
7731
7732 isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
7733 osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
7734
7735 if (isym != NULL
7736 && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
7737 && osym != NULL
7738 && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
7739 {
7740 unsigned int shndx;
7741
7742 shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7743 if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
7744 shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
7745 else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
7746 shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
7747 else if (shndx == elf_strtab_sec (ibfd))
7748 shndx = MAP_STRTAB;
7749 else if (shndx == elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd))
7750 shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
7751 else if (find_section_in_list (shndx, elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)))
7752 shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
7753 osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7754 }
7755
7756 return TRUE;
7757 }
7758
7759 /* Swap out the symbols. */
7760
7761 static bfd_boolean
7762 swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
7763 struct elf_strtab_hash **sttp,
7764 int relocatable_p)
7765 {
7766 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7767 int symcount;
7768 asymbol **syms;
7769 struct elf_strtab_hash *stt;
7770 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7771 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
7772 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
7773 struct elf_sym_strtab *symstrtab;
7774 bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
7775 bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
7776 unsigned long outbound_syms_index;
7777 unsigned long outbound_shndx_index;
7778 int idx;
7779 unsigned int num_locals;
7780 bfd_size_type amt;
7781 bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
7782
7783 if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd, &num_locals))
7784 return FALSE;
7785
7786 /* Dump out the symtabs. */
7787 stt = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
7788 if (stt == NULL)
7789 return FALSE;
7790
7791 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7792 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
7793 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
7794 symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
7795 symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
7796 symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
7797 symtab_hdr->sh_info = num_locals + 1;
7798 symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
7799
7800 symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
7801 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
7802
7803 /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section. */
7804 symstrtab = (struct elf_sym_strtab *) bfd_malloc ((symcount + 1)
7805 * sizeof (*symstrtab));
7806 if (symstrtab == NULL)
7807 {
7808 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7809 return FALSE;
7810 }
7811
7812 outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount,
7813 bed->s->sizeof_sym);
7814 if (outbound_syms == NULL)
7815 {
7816 error_return:
7817 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7818 free (symstrtab);
7819 return FALSE;
7820 }
7821 symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
7822 outbound_syms_index = 0;
7823
7824 outbound_shndx = NULL;
7825 outbound_shndx_index = 0;
7826
7827 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7828 {
7829 symtab_shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
7830 if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
7831 {
7832 amt = (bfd_size_type) (1 + symcount) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7833 outbound_shndx = (bfd_byte *)
7834 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
7835 if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
7836 goto error_return;
7837
7838 symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
7839 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
7840 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
7841 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7842 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7843 }
7844 /* FIXME: What about any other headers in the list ? */
7845 }
7846
7847 /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
7848 {
7849 /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
7850 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7851 sym.st_name = 0;
7852 sym.st_value = 0;
7853 sym.st_size = 0;
7854 sym.st_info = 0;
7855 sym.st_other = 0;
7856 sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
7857 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
7858 symstrtab[0].sym = sym;
7859 symstrtab[0].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
7860 symstrtab[0].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
7861 outbound_syms_index++;
7862 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
7863 outbound_shndx_index++;
7864 }
7865
7866 name_local_sections
7867 = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
7868 && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
7869
7870 syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
7871 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount;)
7872 {
7873 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7874 bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
7875 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
7876 flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
7877 int type;
7878
7879 if (!name_local_sections
7880 && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
7881 {
7882 /* Local section symbols have no name. */
7883 sym.st_name = (unsigned long) -1;
7884 }
7885 else
7886 {
7887 /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
7888 to get the final offset for st_name. */
7889 sym.st_name
7890 = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt, syms[idx]->name,
7891 FALSE);
7892 if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
7893 goto error_return;
7894 }
7895
7896 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
7897
7898 if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
7899 && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
7900 {
7901 /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
7902 and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
7903 how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
7904 sym.st_size = value;
7905 if (type_ptr == NULL
7906 || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
7907 sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
7908 else
7909 sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
7910 sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
7911 (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
7912 }
7913 else
7914 {
7915 asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
7916 unsigned int shndx;
7917
7918 if (sec->output_section)
7919 {
7920 value += sec->output_offset;
7921 sec = sec->output_section;
7922 }
7923
7924 /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
7925 if (! relocatable_p)
7926 value += sec->vma;
7927 sym.st_value = value;
7928 sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
7929
7930 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
7931 && type_ptr != NULL
7932 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
7933 {
7934 /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
7935 not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
7936 by copy_private_symbol_data. */
7937 shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7938 switch (shndx)
7939 {
7940 case MAP_ONESYMTAB:
7941 shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
7942 break;
7943 case MAP_DYNSYMTAB:
7944 shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
7945 break;
7946 case MAP_STRTAB:
7947 shndx = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
7948 break;
7949 case MAP_SHSTRTAB:
7950 shndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
7951 break;
7952 case MAP_SYM_SHNDX:
7953 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7954 shndx = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx;
7955 break;
7956 default:
7957 shndx = SHN_ABS;
7958 break;
7959 }
7960 }
7961 else
7962 {
7963 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
7964
7965 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7966 {
7967 asection *sec2;
7968
7969 /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
7970 we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
7971 knew what to expect of the library, and what to
7972 demand of applications. For example, it
7973 appears that `objcopy' might not set the
7974 section of a symbol to be a section that is
7975 actually in the output file. */
7976 sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
7977 if (sec2 != NULL)
7978 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
7979 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7980 {
7981 /* xgettext:c-format */
7982 _bfd_error_handler
7983 (_("unable to find equivalent output section"
7984 " for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
7985 syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
7986 sec->name);
7987 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
7988 goto error_return;
7989 }
7990 }
7991 }
7992
7993 sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7994 }
7995
7996 if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
7997 type = STT_TLS;
7998 else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
7999 type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
8000 else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
8001 type = STT_FUNC;
8002 else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
8003 type = STT_OBJECT;
8004 else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
8005 type = STT_RELC;
8006 else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
8007 type = STT_SRELC;
8008 else
8009 type = STT_NOTYPE;
8010
8011 if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
8012 type = STT_TLS;
8013
8014 /* Processor-specific types. */
8015 if (type_ptr != NULL
8016 && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8017 type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8018 (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
8019
8020 if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
8021 {
8022 if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8023 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8024 else
8025 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
8026 }
8027 else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
8028 {
8029 if (type != STT_TLS)
8030 {
8031 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_CONVERT_ELF_COMMON))
8032 type = ((abfd->flags & BFD_USE_ELF_STT_COMMON)
8033 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8034 else
8035 type = ((flags & BSF_ELF_COMMON) != 0
8036 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8037 }
8038 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
8039 }
8040 else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
8041 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
8042 ? STB_WEAK
8043 : STB_GLOBAL),
8044 type);
8045 else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
8046 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
8047 else
8048 {
8049 int bind = STB_LOCAL;
8050
8051 if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
8052 bind = STB_LOCAL;
8053 else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
8054 bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
8055 else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
8056 bind = STB_WEAK;
8057 else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8058 bind = STB_GLOBAL;
8059
8060 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
8061 }
8062
8063 if (type_ptr != NULL)
8064 {
8065 sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
8066 sym.st_target_internal
8067 = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
8068 }
8069 else
8070 {
8071 sym.st_other = 0;
8072 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
8073 }
8074
8075 idx++;
8076 symstrtab[idx].sym = sym;
8077 symstrtab[idx].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
8078 symstrtab[idx].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
8079
8080 outbound_syms_index++;
8081 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
8082 outbound_shndx_index++;
8083 }
8084
8085 /* Finalize the .strtab section. */
8086 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt);
8087
8088 /* Swap out the .strtab section. */
8089 for (idx = 0; idx <= symcount; idx++)
8090 {
8091 struct elf_sym_strtab *elfsym = &symstrtab[idx];
8092 if (elfsym->sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
8093 elfsym->sym.st_name = 0;
8094 else
8095 elfsym->sym.st_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt,
8096 elfsym->sym.st_name);
8097 bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &elfsym->sym,
8098 (outbound_syms
8099 + (elfsym->dest_index
8100 * bed->s->sizeof_sym)),
8101 (outbound_shndx
8102 + (elfsym->destshndx_index
8103 * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx))));
8104 }
8105 free (symstrtab);
8106
8107 *sttp = stt;
8108 symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt);
8109 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
8110 symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
8111 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
8112 symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
8113 symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
8114 symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
8115 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
8116
8117 return TRUE;
8118 }
8119
8120 /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
8121
8122 Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
8123 the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
8124 always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
8125
8126 long
8127 _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8128 {
8129 long symcount;
8130 long symtab_size;
8131 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8132
8133 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8134 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8135 if (symcount > 0)
8136 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8137
8138 return symtab_size;
8139 }
8140
8141 long
8142 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8143 {
8144 long symcount;
8145 long symtab_size;
8146 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
8147
8148 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8149 {
8150 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8151 return -1;
8152 }
8153
8154 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8155 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8156 if (symcount > 0)
8157 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8158
8159 return symtab_size;
8160 }
8161
8162 long
8163 _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8164 sec_ptr asect)
8165 {
8166 return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
8167 }
8168
8169 /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
8170
8171 long
8172 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8173 sec_ptr section,
8174 arelent **relptr,
8175 asymbol **symbols)
8176 {
8177 arelent *tblptr;
8178 unsigned int i;
8179 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8180
8181 if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
8182 return -1;
8183
8184 tblptr = section->relocation;
8185 for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
8186 *relptr++ = tblptr++;
8187
8188 *relptr = NULL;
8189
8190 return section->reloc_count;
8191 }
8192
8193 long
8194 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
8195 {
8196 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8197 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
8198
8199 if (symcount >= 0)
8200 bfd_get_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
8201 return symcount;
8202 }
8203
8204 long
8205 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
8206 asymbol **allocation)
8207 {
8208 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8209 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
8210
8211 if (symcount >= 0)
8212 bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
8213 return symcount;
8214 }
8215
8216 /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
8217 section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
8218 or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
8219 dynamic reloc section. */
8220
8221 long
8222 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8223 {
8224 long ret;
8225 asection *s;
8226
8227 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8228 {
8229 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8230 return -1;
8231 }
8232
8233 ret = sizeof (arelent *);
8234 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8235 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8236 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8237 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8238 ret += ((s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize)
8239 * sizeof (arelent *));
8240
8241 return ret;
8242 }
8243
8244 /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
8245 dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
8246 associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
8247 designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
8248 one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
8249 installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
8250 dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
8251
8252 long
8253 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8254 arelent **storage,
8255 asymbol **syms)
8256 {
8257 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
8258 asection *s;
8259 long ret;
8260
8261 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8262 {
8263 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8264 return -1;
8265 }
8266
8267 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
8268 ret = 0;
8269 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8270 {
8271 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8272 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8273 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8274 {
8275 arelent *p;
8276 long count, i;
8277
8278 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
8279 return -1;
8280 count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
8281 p = s->relocation;
8282 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
8283 *storage++ = p++;
8284 ret += count;
8285 }
8286 }
8287
8288 *storage = NULL;
8289
8290 return ret;
8291 }
8292 \f
8293 /* Read in the version information. */
8294
8295 bfd_boolean
8296 _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
8297 {
8298 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
8299 unsigned int freeidx = 0;
8300
8301 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
8302 {
8303 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8304 Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
8305 Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
8306 unsigned int i;
8307 bfd_byte *contents_end;
8308
8309 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
8310
8311 if (hdr->sh_info == 0
8312 || hdr->sh_info > hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
8313 {
8314 error_return_bad_verref:
8315 _bfd_error_handler
8316 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd);
8317 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8318 error_return_verref:
8319 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
8320 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
8321 goto error_return;
8322 }
8323
8324 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
8325 if (contents == NULL)
8326 goto error_return_verref;
8327
8328 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
8329 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
8330 goto error_return_verref;
8331
8332 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *)
8333 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed));
8334
8335 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
8336 goto error_return_verref;
8337
8338 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
8339 == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
8340 contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
8341 everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
8342 iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
8343 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
8344 {
8345 Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
8346 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
8347 unsigned int j;
8348
8349 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
8350
8351 iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
8352
8353 iverneed->vn_filename =
8354 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8355 iverneed->vn_file);
8356 if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
8357 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8358
8359 if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
8360 iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
8361 else
8362 {
8363 iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
8364 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverneed->vn_cnt,
8365 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux));
8366 if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
8367 goto error_return_verref;
8368 }
8369
8370 if (iverneed->vn_aux
8371 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8372 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8373
8374 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8375 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
8376 ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
8377 for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
8378 {
8379 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
8380
8381 ivernaux->vna_nodename =
8382 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8383 ivernaux->vna_name);
8384 if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
8385 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8386
8387 if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
8388 freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
8389
8390 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
8391 if (ivernaux->vna_next == 0)
8392 {
8393 iverneed->vn_cnt = j + 1;
8394 break;
8395 }
8396 if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
8397 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
8398
8399 if (ivernaux->vna_next
8400 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
8401 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8402
8403 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8404 ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
8405 }
8406
8407 iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
8408 if (iverneed->vn_next == 0)
8409 break;
8410 if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
8411 iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
8412
8413 if (iverneed->vn_next
8414 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8415 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8416
8417 everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
8418 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
8419 }
8420 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = i;
8421
8422 free (contents);
8423 contents = NULL;
8424 }
8425
8426 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
8427 {
8428 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8429 Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
8430 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8431 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
8432 Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
8433 unsigned int i;
8434 unsigned int maxidx;
8435 bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
8436
8437 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
8438
8439 if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
8440 {
8441 error_return_bad_verdef:
8442 _bfd_error_handler
8443 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd);
8444 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8445 error_return_verdef:
8446 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
8447 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
8448 goto error_return;
8449 }
8450
8451 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
8452 if (contents == NULL)
8453 goto error_return_verdef;
8454 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
8455 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
8456 goto error_return_verdef;
8457
8458 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
8459 >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
8460 contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
8461 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
8462 contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
8463 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
8464
8465 /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
8466 index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
8467 the maximum. */
8468 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8469 maxidx = 0;
8470 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
8471 {
8472 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8473
8474 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) == 0)
8475 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8476 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
8477 maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
8478
8479 if (iverdefmem.vd_next == 0)
8480 break;
8481
8482 if (iverdefmem.vd_next
8483 > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8484 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8485
8486 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8487 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
8488 }
8489
8490 if (default_imported_symver)
8491 {
8492 if (freeidx > maxidx)
8493 maxidx = ++freeidx;
8494 else
8495 freeidx = ++maxidx;
8496 }
8497
8498 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
8499 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
8500 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8501 goto error_return_verdef;
8502
8503 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
8504
8505 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8506 iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
8507 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
8508 {
8509 Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
8510 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8511 unsigned int j;
8512
8513 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8514
8515 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
8516 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8517
8518 iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
8519 memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef, vd_bfd));
8520
8521 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8522
8523 if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
8524 iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
8525 else
8526 {
8527 iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8528 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverdef->vd_cnt,
8529 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
8530 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8531 goto error_return_verdef;
8532 }
8533
8534 if (iverdef->vd_aux
8535 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8536 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8537
8538 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8539 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
8540 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8541 for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
8542 {
8543 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
8544
8545 iverdaux->vda_nodename =
8546 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8547 iverdaux->vda_name);
8548 if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
8549 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8550
8551 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
8552 if (iverdaux->vda_next == 0)
8553 {
8554 iverdef->vd_cnt = j + 1;
8555 break;
8556 }
8557 if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
8558 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
8559
8560 if (iverdaux->vda_next
8561 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
8562 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8563
8564 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8565 ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
8566 }
8567
8568 iverdef->vd_nodename = NULL;
8569 if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
8570 iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
8571
8572 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8573 if (iverdef->vd_next == 0)
8574 break;
8575 if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
8576 iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
8577
8578 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8579 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
8580 }
8581
8582 free (contents);
8583 contents = NULL;
8584 }
8585 else if (default_imported_symver)
8586 {
8587 if (freeidx < 3)
8588 freeidx = 3;
8589 else
8590 freeidx++;
8591
8592 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
8593 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
8594 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8595 goto error_return;
8596
8597 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
8598 }
8599
8600 /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
8601 if (default_imported_symver)
8602 {
8603 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8604 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8605
8606 iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];
8607
8608 iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
8609 iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
8610 iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
8611 iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
8612
8613 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8614
8615 iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
8616 if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
8617 goto error_return_verdef;
8618 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8619 iverdef->vd_auxptr = ((struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8620 bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux)));
8621 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8622 goto error_return_verdef;
8623
8624 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8625 iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
8626 }
8627
8628 return TRUE;
8629
8630 error_return:
8631 if (contents != NULL)
8632 free (contents);
8633 return FALSE;
8634 }
8635 \f
8636 asymbol *
8637 _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
8638 {
8639 elf_symbol_type *newsym;
8640
8641 newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * newsym);
8642 if (!newsym)
8643 return NULL;
8644 newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
8645 return &newsym->symbol;
8646 }
8647
8648 void
8649 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8650 asymbol *symbol,
8651 symbol_info *ret)
8652 {
8653 bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
8654 }
8655
8656 /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
8657 use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
8658 override it. */
8659
8660 bfd_boolean
8661 _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8662 const char *name)
8663 {
8664 /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
8665 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
8666 return TRUE;
8667
8668 /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
8669 DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
8670 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
8671 return TRUE;
8672
8673 /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
8674 emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
8675 small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
8676 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
8677 underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
8678 we treat such symbols as local. */
8679 if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
8680 return TRUE;
8681
8682 /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
8683 forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
8684 These labels have the form:
8685
8686 L0^A.* (fake symbols)
8687
8688 [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]* (local labels)
8689
8690 Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
8691 so we only need to match the rest. */
8692 if (name[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name[1]))
8693 {
8694 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
8695 const char * p;
8696 char c;
8697
8698 for (p = name + 2; (c = *p); p++)
8699 {
8700 if (c == 1 || c == 2)
8701 {
8702 if (c == 1 && p == name + 2)
8703 /* A fake symbol. */
8704 return TRUE;
8705
8706 /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
8707 L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
8708 assembler will never generate them. But can any symbol
8709 containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
8710 other than some kind of local ? */
8711 ret = TRUE;
8712 }
8713
8714 if (! ISDIGIT (c))
8715 {
8716 ret = FALSE;
8717 break;
8718 }
8719 }
8720 return ret;
8721 }
8722
8723 return FALSE;
8724 }
8725
8726 alent *
8727 _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8728 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8729 {
8730 abort ();
8731 return NULL;
8732 }
8733
8734 bfd_boolean
8735 _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
8736 enum bfd_architecture arch,
8737 unsigned long machine)
8738 {
8739 /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
8740 isn't the generic backend, fail. */
8741 if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
8742 && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
8743 && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
8744 return FALSE;
8745
8746 return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
8747 }
8748
8749 /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
8750 for error reporting. */
8751
8752 bfd_boolean
8753 _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
8754 asymbol **symbols,
8755 asection *section,
8756 bfd_vma offset,
8757 const char **filename_ptr,
8758 const char **functionname_ptr,
8759 unsigned int *line_ptr,
8760 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
8761 {
8762 bfd_boolean found;
8763
8764 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
8765 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8766 line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
8767 dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8768 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info)
8769 || _bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8770 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8771 line_ptr))
8772 {
8773 if (!*functionname_ptr)
8774 _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8775 *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
8776 functionname_ptr);
8777 return TRUE;
8778 }
8779
8780 if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8781 &found, filename_ptr,
8782 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8783 &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
8784 return FALSE;
8785 if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
8786 return TRUE;
8787
8788 if (symbols == NULL)
8789 return FALSE;
8790
8791 if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8792 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
8793 return FALSE;
8794
8795 *line_ptr = 0;
8796 return TRUE;
8797 }
8798
8799 /* Find the line for a symbol. */
8800
8801 bfd_boolean
8802 _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
8803 const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
8804 {
8805 return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, symbol, NULL, 0,
8806 filename_ptr, NULL, line_ptr, NULL,
8807 dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8808 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8809 }
8810
8811 /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
8812 bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
8813 each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
8814 passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
8815 for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
8816
8817 bfd_boolean
8818 _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
8819 const char **filename_ptr,
8820 const char **functionname_ptr,
8821 unsigned int *line_ptr)
8822 {
8823 bfd_boolean found;
8824 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
8825 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8826 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8827 return found;
8828 }
8829
8830 int
8831 _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8832 {
8833 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8834 int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
8835
8836 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8837 {
8838 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
8839
8840 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
8841 {
8842 struct elf_segment_map *m;
8843
8844 phdr_size = 0;
8845 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
8846 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
8847
8848 if (phdr_size == 0)
8849 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
8850 }
8851
8852 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = phdr_size;
8853 ret += phdr_size;
8854 }
8855
8856 return ret;
8857 }
8858
8859 bfd_boolean
8860 _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
8861 sec_ptr section,
8862 const void *location,
8863 file_ptr offset,
8864 bfd_size_type count)
8865 {
8866 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8867 file_ptr pos;
8868
8869 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
8870 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
8871 return FALSE;
8872
8873 if (!count)
8874 return TRUE;
8875
8876 hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
8877 if (hdr->sh_offset == (file_ptr) -1)
8878 {
8879 /* We must compress this section. Write output to the buffer. */
8880 unsigned char *contents = hdr->contents;
8881 if ((offset + count) > hdr->sh_size
8882 || (section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS) == 0
8883 || contents == NULL)
8884 abort ();
8885 memcpy (contents + offset, location, count);
8886 return TRUE;
8887 }
8888 pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
8889 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
8890 || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
8891 return FALSE;
8892
8893 return TRUE;
8894 }
8895
8896 bfd_boolean
8897 _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8898 arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8899 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8900 {
8901 abort ();
8902 return FALSE;
8903 }
8904
8905 /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
8906
8907 bfd_boolean
8908 _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
8909 {
8910 /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
8911
8912 if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
8913 {
8914 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
8915 reloc_howto_type *howto;
8916
8917 /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
8918 equivalent ELF reloc. */
8919
8920 if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
8921 {
8922 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8923 {
8924 case 8:
8925 code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
8926 break;
8927 case 12:
8928 code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
8929 break;
8930 case 16:
8931 code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
8932 break;
8933 case 24:
8934 code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
8935 break;
8936 case 32:
8937 code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
8938 break;
8939 case 64:
8940 code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
8941 break;
8942 default:
8943 goto fail;
8944 }
8945
8946 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8947
8948 if (areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
8949 {
8950 if (howto->pcrel_offset)
8951 areloc->addend += areloc->address;
8952 else
8953 areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
8954 }
8955 }
8956 else
8957 {
8958 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8959 {
8960 case 8:
8961 code = BFD_RELOC_8;
8962 break;
8963 case 14:
8964 code = BFD_RELOC_14;
8965 break;
8966 case 16:
8967 code = BFD_RELOC_16;
8968 break;
8969 case 26:
8970 code = BFD_RELOC_26;
8971 break;
8972 case 32:
8973 code = BFD_RELOC_32;
8974 break;
8975 case 64:
8976 code = BFD_RELOC_64;
8977 break;
8978 default:
8979 goto fail;
8980 }
8981
8982 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8983 }
8984
8985 if (howto)
8986 areloc->howto = howto;
8987 else
8988 goto fail;
8989 }
8990
8991 return TRUE;
8992
8993 fail:
8994 /* xgettext:c-format */
8995 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8996 abfd, areloc->howto->name);
8997 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8998 return FALSE;
8999 }
9000
9001 bfd_boolean
9002 _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
9003 {
9004 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
9005 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object && tdata != NULL)
9006 {
9007 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->o != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
9008 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
9009 _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd, &tdata->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9010 }
9011
9012 return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
9013 }
9014
9015 /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
9016 in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
9017 range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
9018 this reloc. */
9019
9020 bfd_reloc_status_type
9021 _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
9022 (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9023 struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9024 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9025 bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9026 {
9027 return bfd_reloc_ok;
9028 }
9029 \f
9030 /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
9031 toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
9032 machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
9033 out details about the corefile. */
9034
9035 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
9036 /* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris. */
9037 # define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
9038 # include <sys/procfs.h>
9039 #endif
9040
9041 /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
9042 PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
9043
9044 static int
9045 elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
9046 {
9047 int pid;
9048
9049 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid;
9050 if (pid == 0)
9051 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid;
9052
9053 return pid;
9054 }
9055
9056 /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
9057 data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
9058 reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
9059 overwrite it. */
9060
9061 static bfd_boolean
9062 elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
9063 {
9064 asection *sect2;
9065
9066 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
9067 return TRUE;
9068
9069 sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
9070 if (sect2 == NULL)
9071 return FALSE;
9072
9073 sect2->size = sect->size;
9074 sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
9075 sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
9076 return TRUE;
9077 }
9078
9079 /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
9080 actually creates up to two pseudosections:
9081 - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
9082 such a section already exists.
9083 - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
9084 PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
9085 Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
9086 bfd_boolean
9087 _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9088 char *name,
9089 size_t size,
9090 ufile_ptr filepos)
9091 {
9092 char buf[100];
9093 char *threaded_name;
9094 size_t len;
9095 asection *sect;
9096
9097 /* Build the section name. */
9098
9099 sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9100 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9101 threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9102 if (threaded_name == NULL)
9103 return FALSE;
9104 memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
9105
9106 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
9107 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9108 if (sect == NULL)
9109 return FALSE;
9110 sect->size = size;
9111 sect->filepos = filepos;
9112 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9113
9114 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
9115 }
9116
9117 /* prstatus_t exists on:
9118 solaris 2.5+
9119 linux 2.[01] + glibc
9120 unixware 4.2
9121 */
9122
9123 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9124
9125 static bfd_boolean
9126 elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9127 {
9128 size_t size;
9129 int offset;
9130
9131 if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
9132 {
9133 prstatus_t prstat;
9134
9135 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9136 offset = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
9137 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9138
9139 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9140 has already been set by another thread. */
9141 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9142 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9143 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9144 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9145
9146 /* pr_who exists on:
9147 solaris 2.5+
9148 unixware 4.2
9149 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9150 linux 2.[01]
9151 */
9152 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
9153 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9154 #else
9155 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9156 #endif
9157 }
9158 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
9159 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
9160 {
9161 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9162 prstatus32_t prstat;
9163
9164 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9165 offset = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
9166 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9167
9168 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9169 has already been set by another thread. */
9170 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9171 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9172 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9173 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9174
9175 /* pr_who exists on:
9176 solaris 2.5+
9177 unixware 4.2
9178 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9179 linux 2.[01]
9180 */
9181 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
9182 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9183 #else
9184 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9185 #endif
9186 }
9187 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
9188 else
9189 {
9190 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9191 note size (ie. data object type). */
9192 return TRUE;
9193 }
9194
9195 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
9196 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
9197 size, note->descpos + offset);
9198 }
9199 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
9200
9201 /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
9202 static bfd_boolean
9203 elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9204 char *name,
9205 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9206 {
9207 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
9208 note->descsz, note->descpos);
9209 }
9210
9211 /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
9212 but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
9213 data structure apart. */
9214
9215 static bfd_boolean
9216 elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9217 {
9218 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9219 }
9220
9221 /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
9222 type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
9223 literally. */
9224
9225 static bfd_boolean
9226 elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9227 {
9228 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
9229 }
9230
9231 /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
9232 with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
9233 contents literally. */
9234
9235 static bfd_boolean
9236 elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9237 {
9238 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
9239 }
9240
9241 static bfd_boolean
9242 elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9243 {
9244 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
9245 }
9246
9247 static bfd_boolean
9248 elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9249 {
9250 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
9251 }
9252
9253 static bfd_boolean
9254 elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9255 {
9256 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tar", note);
9257 }
9258
9259 static bfd_boolean
9260 elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9261 {
9262 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-ppr", note);
9263 }
9264
9265 static bfd_boolean
9266 elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9267 {
9268 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-dscr", note);
9269 }
9270
9271 static bfd_boolean
9272 elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9273 {
9274 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-ebb", note);
9275 }
9276
9277 static bfd_boolean
9278 elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9279 {
9280 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-pmu", note);
9281 }
9282
9283 static bfd_boolean
9284 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9285 {
9286 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr", note);
9287 }
9288
9289 static bfd_boolean
9290 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9291 {
9292 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr", note);
9293 }
9294
9295 static bfd_boolean
9296 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9297 {
9298 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx", note);
9299 }
9300
9301 static bfd_boolean
9302 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9303 {
9304 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx", note);
9305 }
9306
9307 static bfd_boolean
9308 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9309 {
9310 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr", note);
9311 }
9312
9313 static bfd_boolean
9314 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9315 {
9316 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar", note);
9317 }
9318
9319 static bfd_boolean
9320 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9321 {
9322 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr", note);
9323 }
9324
9325 static bfd_boolean
9326 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9327 {
9328 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr", note);
9329 }
9330
9331 static bfd_boolean
9332 elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9333 {
9334 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
9335 }
9336
9337 static bfd_boolean
9338 elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9339 {
9340 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
9341 }
9342
9343 static bfd_boolean
9344 elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9345 {
9346 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
9347 }
9348
9349 static bfd_boolean
9350 elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9351 {
9352 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
9353 }
9354
9355 static bfd_boolean
9356 elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9357 {
9358 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
9359 }
9360
9361 static bfd_boolean
9362 elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9363 {
9364 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
9365 }
9366
9367 static bfd_boolean
9368 elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9369 {
9370 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-last-break", note);
9371 }
9372
9373 static bfd_boolean
9374 elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9375 {
9376 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-system-call", note);
9377 }
9378
9379 static bfd_boolean
9380 elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9381 {
9382 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-tdb", note);
9383 }
9384
9385 static bfd_boolean
9386 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9387 {
9388 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note);
9389 }
9390
9391 static bfd_boolean
9392 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9393 {
9394 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note);
9395 }
9396
9397 static bfd_boolean
9398 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9399 {
9400 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-cb", note);
9401 }
9402
9403 static bfd_boolean
9404 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9405 {
9406 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-bc", note);
9407 }
9408
9409 static bfd_boolean
9410 elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9411 {
9412 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
9413 }
9414
9415 static bfd_boolean
9416 elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9417 {
9418 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-tls", note);
9419 }
9420
9421 static bfd_boolean
9422 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9423 {
9424 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note);
9425 }
9426
9427 static bfd_boolean
9428 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9429 {
9430 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note);
9431 }
9432
9433 static bfd_boolean
9434 elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9435 {
9436 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-sve", note);
9437 }
9438
9439 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
9440 typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9441 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9442 typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9443 #endif
9444 #endif
9445
9446 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9447 typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9448 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9449 typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9450 #endif
9451 #endif
9452
9453 /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
9454 most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
9455 the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
9456
9457 char *
9458 _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
9459 {
9460 char *dups;
9461 char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
9462 size_t len;
9463
9464 if (end == NULL)
9465 len = max;
9466 else
9467 len = end - start;
9468
9469 dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
9470 if (dups == NULL)
9471 return NULL;
9472
9473 memcpy (dups, start, len);
9474 dups[len] = '\0';
9475
9476 return dups;
9477 }
9478
9479 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9480 static bfd_boolean
9481 elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9482 {
9483 if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
9484 {
9485 elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
9486
9487 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9488
9489 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
9490 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9491 #endif
9492 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9493 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9494 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9495
9496 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9497 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9498 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9499 }
9500 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9501 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
9502 {
9503 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9504 elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
9505
9506 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9507
9508 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
9509 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9510 #endif
9511 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9512 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9513 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9514
9515 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9516 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9517 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9518 }
9519 #endif
9520
9521 else
9522 {
9523 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9524 note size (ie. data object type). */
9525 return TRUE;
9526 }
9527
9528 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
9529 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
9530 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
9531
9532 {
9533 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
9534 int n = strlen (command);
9535
9536 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
9537 command[n - 1] = '\0';
9538 }
9539
9540 return TRUE;
9541 }
9542 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
9543
9544 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9545 static bfd_boolean
9546 elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9547 {
9548 if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
9549 #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
9550 || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
9551 #endif
9552 )
9553 {
9554 pstatus_t pstat;
9555
9556 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9557
9558 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9559 }
9560 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
9561 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
9562 {
9563 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9564 pstatus32_t pstat;
9565
9566 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9567
9568 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9569 }
9570 #endif
9571 /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
9572 lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
9573 NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
9574
9575 return TRUE;
9576 }
9577 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
9578
9579 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9580 static bfd_boolean
9581 elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9582 {
9583 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
9584 char buf[100];
9585 char *name;
9586 size_t len;
9587 asection *sect;
9588
9589 if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
9590 #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
9591 && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
9592 #endif
9593 )
9594 return TRUE;
9595
9596 memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
9597
9598 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
9599 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
9600 another thread. */
9601 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9602 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
9603
9604 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9605
9606 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9607 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9608 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9609 if (name == NULL)
9610 return FALSE;
9611 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9612
9613 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9614 if (sect == NULL)
9615 return FALSE;
9616
9617 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9618 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
9619 sect->filepos = note->descpos
9620 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
9621 #endif
9622
9623 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
9624 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
9625 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
9626 #endif
9627
9628 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9629
9630 if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
9631 return FALSE;
9632
9633 /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
9634
9635 sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9636 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9637 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9638 if (name == NULL)
9639 return FALSE;
9640 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9641
9642 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9643 if (sect == NULL)
9644 return FALSE;
9645
9646 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9647 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
9648 sect->filepos = note->descpos
9649 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
9650 #endif
9651
9652 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
9653 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
9654 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
9655 #endif
9656
9657 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9658
9659 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
9660 }
9661 #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
9662
9663 static bfd_boolean
9664 elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9665 {
9666 char buf[30];
9667 char *name;
9668 size_t len;
9669 asection *sect;
9670 int type;
9671 int is_active_thread;
9672 bfd_vma base_addr;
9673
9674 if (note->descsz < 728)
9675 return TRUE;
9676
9677 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
9678 return TRUE;
9679
9680 type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
9681
9682 switch (type)
9683 {
9684 case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
9685 /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command. */
9686 /* process_info.pid */
9687 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9688 /* process_info.signal */
9689 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
9690 break;
9691
9692 case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
9693 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9694 /* thread_info.tid */
9695 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8));
9696
9697 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9698 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9699 if (name == NULL)
9700 return FALSE;
9701
9702 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9703
9704 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9705 if (sect == NULL)
9706 return FALSE;
9707
9708 /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9709 sect->size = 716;
9710 /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9711 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
9712 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9713
9714 /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
9715 is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9716
9717 if (is_active_thread)
9718 if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
9719 return FALSE;
9720 break;
9721
9722 case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
9723 /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
9724 /* module_info.base_address */
9725 base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
9726 sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
9727
9728 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9729 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9730 if (name == NULL)
9731 return FALSE;
9732
9733 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9734
9735 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9736
9737 if (sect == NULL)
9738 return FALSE;
9739
9740 sect->size = note->descsz;
9741 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9742 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9743 break;
9744
9745 default:
9746 return TRUE;
9747 }
9748
9749 return TRUE;
9750 }
9751
9752 static bfd_boolean
9753 elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9754 {
9755 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9756
9757 switch (note->type)
9758 {
9759 default:
9760 return TRUE;
9761
9762 case NT_PRSTATUS:
9763 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
9764 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
9765 return TRUE;
9766 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9767 return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
9768 #else
9769 return TRUE;
9770 #endif
9771
9772 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9773 case NT_PSTATUS:
9774 return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
9775 #endif
9776
9777 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9778 case NT_LWPSTATUS:
9779 return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
9780 #endif
9781
9782 case NT_FPREGSET: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
9783 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
9784
9785 case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
9786 return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
9787
9788 case NT_PRXFPREG: /* Linux SSE extension */
9789 if (note->namesz == 6
9790 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9791 return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
9792 else
9793 return TRUE;
9794
9795 case NT_X86_XSTATE: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
9796 if (note->namesz == 6
9797 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9798 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
9799 else
9800 return TRUE;
9801
9802 case NT_PPC_VMX:
9803 if (note->namesz == 6
9804 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9805 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
9806 else
9807 return TRUE;
9808
9809 case NT_PPC_VSX:
9810 if (note->namesz == 6
9811 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9812 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
9813 else
9814 return TRUE;
9815
9816 case NT_PPC_TAR:
9817 if (note->namesz == 6
9818 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9819 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (abfd, note);
9820 else
9821 return TRUE;
9822
9823 case NT_PPC_PPR:
9824 if (note->namesz == 6
9825 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9826 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (abfd, note);
9827 else
9828 return TRUE;
9829
9830 case NT_PPC_DSCR:
9831 if (note->namesz == 6
9832 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9833 return elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (abfd, note);
9834 else
9835 return TRUE;
9836
9837 case NT_PPC_EBB:
9838 if (note->namesz == 6
9839 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9840 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (abfd, note);
9841 else
9842 return TRUE;
9843
9844 case NT_PPC_PMU:
9845 if (note->namesz == 6
9846 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9847 return elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (abfd, note);
9848 else
9849 return TRUE;
9850
9851 case NT_PPC_TM_CGPR:
9852 if (note->namesz == 6
9853 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9854 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd, note);
9855 else
9856 return TRUE;
9857
9858 case NT_PPC_TM_CFPR:
9859 if (note->namesz == 6
9860 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9861 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd, note);
9862 else
9863 return TRUE;
9864
9865 case NT_PPC_TM_CVMX:
9866 if (note->namesz == 6
9867 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9868 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd, note);
9869 else
9870 return TRUE;
9871
9872 case NT_PPC_TM_CVSX:
9873 if (note->namesz == 6
9874 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9875 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd, note);
9876 else
9877 return TRUE;
9878
9879 case NT_PPC_TM_SPR:
9880 if (note->namesz == 6
9881 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9882 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (abfd, note);
9883 else
9884 return TRUE;
9885
9886 case NT_PPC_TM_CTAR:
9887 if (note->namesz == 6
9888 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9889 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd, note);
9890 else
9891 return TRUE;
9892
9893 case NT_PPC_TM_CPPR:
9894 if (note->namesz == 6
9895 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9896 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd, note);
9897 else
9898 return TRUE;
9899
9900 case NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR:
9901 if (note->namesz == 6
9902 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9903 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd, note);
9904 else
9905 return TRUE;
9906
9907 case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
9908 if (note->namesz == 6
9909 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9910 return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
9911 else
9912 return TRUE;
9913
9914 case NT_S390_TIMER:
9915 if (note->namesz == 6
9916 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9917 return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
9918 else
9919 return TRUE;
9920
9921 case NT_S390_TODCMP:
9922 if (note->namesz == 6
9923 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9924 return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
9925 else
9926 return TRUE;
9927
9928 case NT_S390_TODPREG:
9929 if (note->namesz == 6
9930 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9931 return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
9932 else
9933 return TRUE;
9934
9935 case NT_S390_CTRS:
9936 if (note->namesz == 6
9937 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9938 return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
9939 else
9940 return TRUE;
9941
9942 case NT_S390_PREFIX:
9943 if (note->namesz == 6
9944 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9945 return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
9946 else
9947 return TRUE;
9948
9949 case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK:
9950 if (note->namesz == 6
9951 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9952 return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd, note);
9953 else
9954 return TRUE;
9955
9956 case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL:
9957 if (note->namesz == 6
9958 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9959 return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd, note);
9960 else
9961 return TRUE;
9962
9963 case NT_S390_TDB:
9964 if (note->namesz == 6
9965 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9966 return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd, note);
9967 else
9968 return TRUE;
9969
9970 case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW:
9971 if (note->namesz == 6
9972 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9973 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, note);
9974 else
9975 return TRUE;
9976
9977 case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH:
9978 if (note->namesz == 6
9979 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9980 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, note);
9981 else
9982 return TRUE;
9983
9984 case NT_S390_GS_CB:
9985 if (note->namesz == 6
9986 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9987 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (abfd, note);
9988 else
9989 return TRUE;
9990
9991 case NT_S390_GS_BC:
9992 if (note->namesz == 6
9993 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9994 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (abfd, note);
9995 else
9996 return TRUE;
9997
9998 case NT_ARM_VFP:
9999 if (note->namesz == 6
10000 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10001 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10002 else
10003 return TRUE;
10004
10005 case NT_ARM_TLS:
10006 if (note->namesz == 6
10007 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10008 return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd, note);
10009 else
10010 return TRUE;
10011
10012 case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK:
10013 if (note->namesz == 6
10014 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10015 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd, note);
10016 else
10017 return TRUE;
10018
10019 case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH:
10020 if (note->namesz == 6
10021 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10022 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, note);
10023 else
10024 return TRUE;
10025
10026 case NT_ARM_SVE:
10027 if (note->namesz == 6
10028 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10029 return elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (abfd, note);
10030 else
10031 return TRUE;
10032
10033 case NT_PRPSINFO:
10034 case NT_PSINFO:
10035 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
10036 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
10037 return TRUE;
10038 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10039 return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
10040 #else
10041 return TRUE;
10042 #endif
10043
10044 case NT_AUXV:
10045 {
10046 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
10047 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10048
10049 if (sect == NULL)
10050 return FALSE;
10051 sect->size = note->descsz;
10052 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10053 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10054
10055 return TRUE;
10056 }
10057
10058 case NT_FILE:
10059 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.file",
10060 note);
10061
10062 case NT_SIGINFO:
10063 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
10064 note);
10065
10066 }
10067 }
10068
10069 static bfd_boolean
10070 elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10071 {
10072 struct bfd_build_id* build_id;
10073
10074 if (note->descsz == 0)
10075 return FALSE;
10076
10077 build_id = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id) - 1 + note->descsz);
10078 if (build_id == NULL)
10079 return FALSE;
10080
10081 build_id->size = note->descsz;
10082 memcpy (build_id->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
10083 abfd->build_id = build_id;
10084
10085 return TRUE;
10086 }
10087
10088 static bfd_boolean
10089 elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10090 {
10091 switch (note->type)
10092 {
10093 default:
10094 return TRUE;
10095
10096 case NT_GNU_PROPERTY_TYPE_0:
10097 return _bfd_elf_parse_gnu_properties (abfd, note);
10098
10099 case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
10100 return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
10101 }
10102 }
10103
10104 static bfd_boolean
10105 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10106 {
10107 struct sdt_note *cur =
10108 (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct sdt_note)
10109 + note->descsz);
10110
10111 cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
10112 cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
10113 memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
10114
10115 elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
10116
10117 return TRUE;
10118 }
10119
10120 static bfd_boolean
10121 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10122 {
10123 switch (note->type)
10124 {
10125 case NT_STAPSDT:
10126 return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
10127
10128 default:
10129 return TRUE;
10130 }
10131 }
10132
10133 static bfd_boolean
10134 elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10135 {
10136 size_t offset;
10137
10138 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
10139 {
10140 case ELFCLASS32:
10141 if (note->descsz < 108)
10142 return FALSE;
10143 break;
10144
10145 case ELFCLASS64:
10146 if (note->descsz < 120)
10147 return FALSE;
10148 break;
10149
10150 default:
10151 return FALSE;
10152 }
10153
10154 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10155 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
10156 return FALSE;
10157
10158 offset = 4;
10159
10160 /* Skip over pr_psinfosz. */
10161 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
10162 offset += 4;
10163 else
10164 {
10165 offset += 4; /* Padding before pr_psinfosz. */
10166 offset += 8;
10167 }
10168
10169 /* pr_fname is PRFNAMESZ (16) + 1 bytes in size. */
10170 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
10171 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 17);
10172 offset += 17;
10173
10174 /* pr_psargs is PRARGSZ (80) + 1 bytes in size. */
10175 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10176 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 81);
10177 offset += 81;
10178
10179 /* Padding before pr_pid. */
10180 offset += 2;
10181
10182 /* The pr_pid field was added in version "1a". */
10183 if (note->descsz < offset + 4)
10184 return TRUE;
10185
10186 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10187 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10188
10189 return TRUE;
10190 }
10191
10192 static bfd_boolean
10193 elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10194 {
10195 size_t offset;
10196 size_t size;
10197 size_t min_size;
10198
10199 /* Compute offset of pr_getregsz, skipping over pr_statussz.
10200 Also compute minimum size of this note. */
10201 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
10202 {
10203 case ELFCLASS32:
10204 offset = 4 + 4;
10205 min_size = offset + (4 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4;
10206 break;
10207
10208 case ELFCLASS64:
10209 offset = 4 + 4 + 8; /* Includes padding before pr_statussz. */
10210 min_size = offset + (8 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4 + 4;
10211 break;
10212
10213 default:
10214 return FALSE;
10215 }
10216
10217 if (note->descsz < min_size)
10218 return FALSE;
10219
10220 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10221 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
10222 return FALSE;
10223
10224 /* Extract size of pr_reg from pr_gregsetsz. */
10225 /* Skip over pr_gregsetsz and pr_fpregsetsz. */
10226 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
10227 {
10228 size = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10229 offset += 4 * 2;
10230 }
10231 else
10232 {
10233 size = bfd_h_get_64 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10234 offset += 8 * 2;
10235 }
10236
10237 /* Skip over pr_osreldate. */
10238 offset += 4;
10239
10240 /* Read signal from pr_cursig. */
10241 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
10242 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10243 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10244 offset += 4;
10245
10246 /* Read TID from pr_pid. */
10247 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid
10248 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10249 offset += 4;
10250
10251 /* Padding before pr_reg. */
10252 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
10253 offset += 4;
10254
10255 /* Make sure that there is enough data remaining in the note. */
10256 if ((note->descsz - offset) < size)
10257 return FALSE;
10258
10259 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
10260 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
10261 size, note->descpos + offset);
10262 }
10263
10264 static bfd_boolean
10265 elfcore_grok_freebsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10266 {
10267 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10268
10269 switch (note->type)
10270 {
10271 case NT_PRSTATUS:
10272 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus)
10273 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus) (abfd, note))
10274 return TRUE;
10275 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (abfd, note);
10276
10277 case NT_FPREGSET:
10278 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
10279
10280 case NT_PRPSINFO:
10281 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (abfd, note);
10282
10283 case NT_FREEBSD_THRMISC:
10284 if (note->namesz == 8)
10285 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".thrmisc", note);
10286 else
10287 return TRUE;
10288
10289 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_PROC:
10290 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.proc",
10291 note);
10292
10293 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_FILES:
10294 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.files",
10295 note);
10296
10297 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_VMMAP:
10298 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.vmmap",
10299 note);
10300
10301 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_AUXV:
10302 {
10303 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
10304 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10305
10306 if (sect == NULL)
10307 return FALSE;
10308 sect->size = note->descsz - 4;
10309 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 4;
10310 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10311
10312 return TRUE;
10313 }
10314
10315 case NT_X86_XSTATE:
10316 if (note->namesz == 8)
10317 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
10318 else
10319 return TRUE;
10320
10321 case NT_FREEBSD_PTLWPINFO:
10322 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.lwpinfo",
10323 note);
10324
10325 case NT_ARM_VFP:
10326 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10327
10328 default:
10329 return TRUE;
10330 }
10331 }
10332
10333 static bfd_boolean
10334 elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
10335 {
10336 char *cp;
10337
10338 cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
10339 if (cp != NULL)
10340 {
10341 *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
10342 return TRUE;
10343 }
10344 return FALSE;
10345 }
10346
10347 static bfd_boolean
10348 elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10349 {
10350 if (note->descsz <= 0x7c + 31)
10351 return FALSE;
10352
10353 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10354 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10355 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10356
10357 /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
10358 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10359 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
10360
10361 /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10362 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10363 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
10364
10365 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
10366 note);
10367 }
10368
10369 static bfd_boolean
10370 elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10371 {
10372 int lwp;
10373
10374 if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
10375 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwp;
10376
10377 if (note->type == NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO)
10378 {
10379 /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
10380 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
10381 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
10382 creates a core file. */
10383
10384 return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10385 }
10386
10387 /* As of Jan 2002 there are no other machine-independent notes
10388 defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
10389 than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
10390 understand it. */
10391
10392 if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
10393 return TRUE;
10394
10395
10396 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
10397 {
10398 /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
10399 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
10400
10401 case bfd_arch_alpha:
10402 case bfd_arch_sparc:
10403 switch (note->type)
10404 {
10405 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
10406 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10407
10408 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
10409 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10410
10411 default:
10412 return TRUE;
10413 }
10414
10415 /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
10416 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
10417
10418 default:
10419 switch (note->type)
10420 {
10421 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
10422 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10423
10424 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
10425 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10426
10427 default:
10428 return TRUE;
10429 }
10430 }
10431 /* NOTREACHED */
10432 }
10433
10434 static bfd_boolean
10435 elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10436 {
10437 if (note->descsz <= 0x48 + 31)
10438 return FALSE;
10439
10440 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10441 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10442 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10443
10444 /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
10445 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10446 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
10447
10448 /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10449 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10450 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
10451
10452 return TRUE;
10453 }
10454
10455 static bfd_boolean
10456 elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10457 {
10458 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
10459 return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10460
10461 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
10462 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10463
10464 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
10465 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10466
10467 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
10468 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
10469
10470 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
10471 {
10472 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
10473 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10474
10475 if (sect == NULL)
10476 return FALSE;
10477 sect->size = note->descsz;
10478 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10479 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10480
10481 return TRUE;
10482 }
10483
10484 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
10485 {
10486 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
10487 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10488
10489 if (sect == NULL)
10490 return FALSE;
10491 sect->size = note->descsz;
10492 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10493 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10494
10495 return TRUE;
10496 }
10497
10498 return TRUE;
10499 }
10500
10501 static bfd_boolean
10502 elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
10503 {
10504 void *ddata = note->descdata;
10505 char buf[100];
10506 char *name;
10507 asection *sect;
10508 short sig;
10509 unsigned flags;
10510
10511 if (note->descsz < 16)
10512 return FALSE;
10513
10514 /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
10515 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
10516
10517 /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
10518 *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
10519
10520 /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
10521 flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
10522
10523 /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
10524 if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
10525 {
10526 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = sig;
10527 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10528 }
10529
10530 /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
10531 do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
10532 thread just in case. */
10533 if (flags & 0x00000080)
10534 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10535
10536 /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
10537 sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
10538
10539 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10540 if (name == NULL)
10541 return FALSE;
10542 strcpy (name, buf);
10543
10544 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10545 if (sect == NULL)
10546 return FALSE;
10547
10548 sect->size = note->descsz;
10549 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10550 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10551
10552 return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
10553 }
10554
10555 static bfd_boolean
10556 elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
10557 Elf_Internal_Note *note,
10558 long tid,
10559 char *base)
10560 {
10561 char buf[100];
10562 char *name;
10563 asection *sect;
10564
10565 /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
10566 sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
10567
10568 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10569 if (name == NULL)
10570 return FALSE;
10571 strcpy (name, buf);
10572
10573 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10574 if (sect == NULL)
10575 return FALSE;
10576
10577 sect->size = note->descsz;
10578 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10579 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10580
10581 /* This is the current thread. */
10582 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid == tid)
10583 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
10584
10585 return TRUE;
10586 }
10587
10588 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
10589 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
10590 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
10591 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
10592
10593 static bfd_boolean
10594 elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10595 {
10596 /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
10597 tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
10598 function. */
10599 static long tid = 1;
10600
10601 switch (note->type)
10602 {
10603 case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
10604 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
10605 case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
10606 return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
10607 case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
10608 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
10609 case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
10610 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
10611 default:
10612 return TRUE;
10613 }
10614 }
10615
10616 static bfd_boolean
10617 elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10618 {
10619 char *name;
10620 asection *sect;
10621 size_t len;
10622
10623 /* Use note name as section name. */
10624 len = note->namesz;
10625 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10626 if (name == NULL)
10627 return FALSE;
10628 memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
10629 name[len - 1] = '\0';
10630
10631 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10632 if (sect == NULL)
10633 return FALSE;
10634
10635 sect->size = note->descsz;
10636 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10637 sect->alignment_power = 1;
10638
10639 return TRUE;
10640 }
10641
10642 /* Function: elfcore_write_note
10643
10644 Inputs:
10645 buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
10646 name of note
10647 type of note
10648 data for note
10649 size of data for note
10650
10651 Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
10652 for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
10653 that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
10654 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
10655
10656 Return:
10657 Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
10658
10659 char *
10660 elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
10661 char *buf,
10662 int *bufsiz,
10663 const char *name,
10664 int type,
10665 const void *input,
10666 int size)
10667 {
10668 Elf_External_Note *xnp;
10669 size_t namesz;
10670 size_t newspace;
10671 char *dest;
10672
10673 namesz = 0;
10674 if (name != NULL)
10675 namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
10676
10677 newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
10678
10679 buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
10680 if (buf == NULL)
10681 return buf;
10682 dest = buf + *bufsiz;
10683 *bufsiz += newspace;
10684 xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
10685 H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
10686 H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
10687 H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
10688 dest = xnp->name;
10689 if (name != NULL)
10690 {
10691 memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
10692 dest += namesz;
10693 while (namesz & 3)
10694 {
10695 *dest++ = '\0';
10696 ++namesz;
10697 }
10698 }
10699 memcpy (dest, input, size);
10700 dest += size;
10701 while (size & 3)
10702 {
10703 *dest++ = '\0';
10704 ++size;
10705 }
10706 return buf;
10707 }
10708
10709 /* gcc-8 warns (*) on all the strncpy calls in this function about
10710 possible string truncation. The "truncation" is not a bug. We
10711 have an external representation of structs with fields that are not
10712 necessarily NULL terminated and corresponding internal
10713 representation fields that are one larger so that they can always
10714 be NULL terminated.
10715 gcc versions between 4.2 and 4.6 do not allow pragma control of
10716 diagnostics inside functions, giving a hard error if you try to use
10717 the finer control available with later versions.
10718 gcc prior to 4.2 warns about diagnostic push and pop.
10719 gcc-5, gcc-6 and gcc-7 warn that -Wstringop-truncation is unknown,
10720 unless you also add #pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragma".
10721 (*) Depending on your system header files! */
10722 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
10723 # pragma GCC diagnostic push
10724 # pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wstringop-truncation"
10725 #endif
10726 char *
10727 elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd *abfd,
10728 char *buf,
10729 int *bufsiz,
10730 const char *fname,
10731 const char *psargs)
10732 {
10733 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10734
10735 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
10736 {
10737 char *ret;
10738 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10739 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
10740 if (ret != NULL)
10741 return ret;
10742 }
10743
10744 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10745 # if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10746 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10747 {
10748 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10749 psinfo32_t data;
10750 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
10751 # else
10752 prpsinfo32_t data;
10753 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
10754 # endif
10755
10756 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
10757 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
10758 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
10759 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10760 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
10761 }
10762 else
10763 # endif
10764 {
10765 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10766 psinfo_t data;
10767 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
10768 # else
10769 prpsinfo_t data;
10770 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
10771 # endif
10772
10773 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
10774 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
10775 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
10776 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10777 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
10778 }
10779 #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
10780
10781 free (buf);
10782 return NULL;
10783 }
10784 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
10785 # pragma GCC diagnostic pop
10786 #endif
10787
10788 char *
10789 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
10790 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10791 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
10792 {
10793 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16)
10794 {
10795 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16 data;
10796
10797 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10798 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
10799 &data, sizeof (data));
10800 }
10801 else
10802 {
10803 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32 data;
10804
10805 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10806 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
10807 &data, sizeof (data));
10808 }
10809 }
10810
10811 char *
10812 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
10813 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10814 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
10815 {
10816 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16)
10817 {
10818 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16 data;
10819
10820 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10821 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10822 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
10823 }
10824 else
10825 {
10826 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32 data;
10827
10828 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10829 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10830 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
10831 }
10832 }
10833
10834 char *
10835 elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
10836 char *buf,
10837 int *bufsiz,
10838 long pid,
10839 int cursig,
10840 const void *gregs)
10841 {
10842 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10843
10844 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
10845 {
10846 char *ret;
10847 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10848 NT_PRSTATUS,
10849 pid, cursig, gregs);
10850 if (ret != NULL)
10851 return ret;
10852 }
10853
10854 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
10855 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
10856 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10857 {
10858 prstatus32_t prstat;
10859
10860 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
10861 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
10862 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10863 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
10864 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
10865 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
10866 }
10867 else
10868 #endif
10869 {
10870 prstatus_t prstat;
10871
10872 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
10873 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
10874 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10875 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
10876 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
10877 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
10878 }
10879 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
10880
10881 free (buf);
10882 return NULL;
10883 }
10884
10885 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10886 char *
10887 elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
10888 char *buf,
10889 int *bufsiz,
10890 long pid,
10891 int cursig,
10892 const void *gregs)
10893 {
10894 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
10895 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10896
10897 memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
10898 lwpstat.pr_lwpid = pid >> 16;
10899 lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10900 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
10901 memcpy (&lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
10902 #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10903 #if !defined(gregs)
10904 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
10905 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
10906 #else
10907 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
10908 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
10909 #endif
10910 #endif
10911 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10912 NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
10913 }
10914 #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
10915
10916 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10917 char *
10918 elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
10919 char *buf,
10920 int *bufsiz,
10921 long pid,
10922 int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10923 const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10924 {
10925 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10926 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
10927 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10928
10929 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10930 {
10931 pstatus32_t pstat;
10932
10933 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
10934 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
10935 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10936 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
10937 return buf;
10938 }
10939 else
10940 #endif
10941 {
10942 pstatus_t pstat;
10943
10944 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
10945 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
10946 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10947 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
10948 return buf;
10949 }
10950 }
10951 #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
10952
10953 char *
10954 elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
10955 char *buf,
10956 int *bufsiz,
10957 const void *fpregs,
10958 int size)
10959 {
10960 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10961 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10962 note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
10963 }
10964
10965 char *
10966 elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
10967 char *buf,
10968 int *bufsiz,
10969 const void *xfpregs,
10970 int size)
10971 {
10972 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10973 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10974 note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
10975 }
10976
10977 char *
10978 elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10979 const void *xfpregs, int size)
10980 {
10981 char *note_name;
10982 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi == ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
10983 note_name = "FreeBSD";
10984 else
10985 note_name = "LINUX";
10986 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10987 note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
10988 }
10989
10990 char *
10991 elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
10992 char *buf,
10993 int *bufsiz,
10994 const void *ppc_vmx,
10995 int size)
10996 {
10997 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10998 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10999 note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
11000 }
11001
11002 char *
11003 elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
11004 char *buf,
11005 int *bufsiz,
11006 const void *ppc_vsx,
11007 int size)
11008 {
11009 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11010 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11011 note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
11012 }
11013
11014 char *
11015 elfcore_write_ppc_tar (bfd *abfd,
11016 char *buf,
11017 int *bufsiz,
11018 const void *ppc_tar,
11019 int size)
11020 {
11021 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11022 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11023 note_name, NT_PPC_TAR, ppc_tar, size);
11024 }
11025
11026 char *
11027 elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (bfd *abfd,
11028 char *buf,
11029 int *bufsiz,
11030 const void *ppc_ppr,
11031 int size)
11032 {
11033 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11034 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11035 note_name, NT_PPC_PPR, ppc_ppr, size);
11036 }
11037
11038 char *
11039 elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (bfd *abfd,
11040 char *buf,
11041 int *bufsiz,
11042 const void *ppc_dscr,
11043 int size)
11044 {
11045 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11046 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11047 note_name, NT_PPC_DSCR, ppc_dscr, size);
11048 }
11049
11050 char *
11051 elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (bfd *abfd,
11052 char *buf,
11053 int *bufsiz,
11054 const void *ppc_ebb,
11055 int size)
11056 {
11057 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11058 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11059 note_name, NT_PPC_EBB, ppc_ebb, size);
11060 }
11061
11062 char *
11063 elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (bfd *abfd,
11064 char *buf,
11065 int *bufsiz,
11066 const void *ppc_pmu,
11067 int size)
11068 {
11069 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11070 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11071 note_name, NT_PPC_PMU, ppc_pmu, size);
11072 }
11073
11074 char *
11075 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd *abfd,
11076 char *buf,
11077 int *bufsiz,
11078 const void *ppc_tm_cgpr,
11079 int size)
11080 {
11081 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11082 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11083 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CGPR, ppc_tm_cgpr, size);
11084 }
11085
11086 char *
11087 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd *abfd,
11088 char *buf,
11089 int *bufsiz,
11090 const void *ppc_tm_cfpr,
11091 int size)
11092 {
11093 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11094 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11095 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CFPR, ppc_tm_cfpr, size);
11096 }
11097
11098 char *
11099 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd *abfd,
11100 char *buf,
11101 int *bufsiz,
11102 const void *ppc_tm_cvmx,
11103 int size)
11104 {
11105 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11106 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11107 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CVMX, ppc_tm_cvmx, size);
11108 }
11109
11110 char *
11111 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd *abfd,
11112 char *buf,
11113 int *bufsiz,
11114 const void *ppc_tm_cvsx,
11115 int size)
11116 {
11117 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11118 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11119 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CVSX, ppc_tm_cvsx, size);
11120 }
11121
11122 char *
11123 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (bfd *abfd,
11124 char *buf,
11125 int *bufsiz,
11126 const void *ppc_tm_spr,
11127 int size)
11128 {
11129 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11130 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11131 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_SPR, ppc_tm_spr, size);
11132 }
11133
11134 char *
11135 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd *abfd,
11136 char *buf,
11137 int *bufsiz,
11138 const void *ppc_tm_ctar,
11139 int size)
11140 {
11141 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11142 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11143 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CTAR, ppc_tm_ctar, size);
11144 }
11145
11146 char *
11147 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd *abfd,
11148 char *buf,
11149 int *bufsiz,
11150 const void *ppc_tm_cppr,
11151 int size)
11152 {
11153 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11154 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11155 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CPPR, ppc_tm_cppr, size);
11156 }
11157
11158 char *
11159 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd *abfd,
11160 char *buf,
11161 int *bufsiz,
11162 const void *ppc_tm_cdscr,
11163 int size)
11164 {
11165 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11166 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11167 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR, ppc_tm_cdscr, size);
11168 }
11169
11170 static char *
11171 elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
11172 char *buf,
11173 int *bufsiz,
11174 const void *s390_high_gprs,
11175 int size)
11176 {
11177 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11178 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11179 note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
11180 s390_high_gprs, size);
11181 }
11182
11183 char *
11184 elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
11185 char *buf,
11186 int *bufsiz,
11187 const void *s390_timer,
11188 int size)
11189 {
11190 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11191 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11192 note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
11193 }
11194
11195 char *
11196 elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
11197 char *buf,
11198 int *bufsiz,
11199 const void *s390_todcmp,
11200 int size)
11201 {
11202 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11203 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11204 note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
11205 }
11206
11207 char *
11208 elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
11209 char *buf,
11210 int *bufsiz,
11211 const void *s390_todpreg,
11212 int size)
11213 {
11214 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11215 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11216 note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
11217 }
11218
11219 char *
11220 elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
11221 char *buf,
11222 int *bufsiz,
11223 const void *s390_ctrs,
11224 int size)
11225 {
11226 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11227 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11228 note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
11229 }
11230
11231 char *
11232 elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
11233 char *buf,
11234 int *bufsiz,
11235 const void *s390_prefix,
11236 int size)
11237 {
11238 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11239 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11240 note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
11241 }
11242
11243 char *
11244 elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd,
11245 char *buf,
11246 int *bufsiz,
11247 const void *s390_last_break,
11248 int size)
11249 {
11250 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11251 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11252 note_name, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK,
11253 s390_last_break, size);
11254 }
11255
11256 char *
11257 elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd,
11258 char *buf,
11259 int *bufsiz,
11260 const void *s390_system_call,
11261 int size)
11262 {
11263 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11264 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11265 note_name, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL,
11266 s390_system_call, size);
11267 }
11268
11269 char *
11270 elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd,
11271 char *buf,
11272 int *bufsiz,
11273 const void *s390_tdb,
11274 int size)
11275 {
11276 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11277 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11278 note_name, NT_S390_TDB, s390_tdb, size);
11279 }
11280
11281 char *
11282 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd,
11283 char *buf,
11284 int *bufsiz,
11285 const void *s390_vxrs_low,
11286 int size)
11287 {
11288 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11289 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11290 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW, s390_vxrs_low, size);
11291 }
11292
11293 char *
11294 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd,
11295 char *buf,
11296 int *bufsiz,
11297 const void *s390_vxrs_high,
11298 int size)
11299 {
11300 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11301 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11302 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH,
11303 s390_vxrs_high, size);
11304 }
11305
11306 char *
11307 elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd,
11308 char *buf,
11309 int *bufsiz,
11310 const void *s390_gs_cb,
11311 int size)
11312 {
11313 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11314 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11315 note_name, NT_S390_GS_CB,
11316 s390_gs_cb, size);
11317 }
11318
11319 char *
11320 elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd,
11321 char *buf,
11322 int *bufsiz,
11323 const void *s390_gs_bc,
11324 int size)
11325 {
11326 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11327 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11328 note_name, NT_S390_GS_BC,
11329 s390_gs_bc, size);
11330 }
11331
11332 char *
11333 elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
11334 char *buf,
11335 int *bufsiz,
11336 const void *arm_vfp,
11337 int size)
11338 {
11339 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11340 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11341 note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
11342 }
11343
11344 char *
11345 elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd,
11346 char *buf,
11347 int *bufsiz,
11348 const void *aarch_tls,
11349 int size)
11350 {
11351 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11352 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11353 note_name, NT_ARM_TLS, aarch_tls, size);
11354 }
11355
11356 char *
11357 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd,
11358 char *buf,
11359 int *bufsiz,
11360 const void *aarch_hw_break,
11361 int size)
11362 {
11363 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11364 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11365 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK, aarch_hw_break, size);
11366 }
11367
11368 char *
11369 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd,
11370 char *buf,
11371 int *bufsiz,
11372 const void *aarch_hw_watch,
11373 int size)
11374 {
11375 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11376 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11377 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH, aarch_hw_watch, size);
11378 }
11379
11380 char *
11381 elfcore_write_aarch_sve (bfd *abfd,
11382 char *buf,
11383 int *bufsiz,
11384 const void *aarch_sve,
11385 int size)
11386 {
11387 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11388 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11389 note_name, NT_ARM_SVE, aarch_sve, size);
11390 }
11391
11392 char *
11393 elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
11394 char *buf,
11395 int *bufsiz,
11396 const char *section,
11397 const void *data,
11398 int size)
11399 {
11400 if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
11401 return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11402 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
11403 return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11404 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
11405 return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11406 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
11407 return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11408 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
11409 return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11410 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tar") == 0)
11411 return elfcore_write_ppc_tar (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11412 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-ppr") == 0)
11413 return elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11414 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-dscr") == 0)
11415 return elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11416 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-ebb") == 0)
11417 return elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11418 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-pmu") == 0)
11419 return elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11420 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr") == 0)
11421 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11422 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr") == 0)
11423 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11424 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx") == 0)
11425 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11426 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx") == 0)
11427 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11428 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr") == 0)
11429 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11430 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar") == 0)
11431 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11432 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr") == 0)
11433 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11434 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr") == 0)
11435 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11436 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
11437 return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11438 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
11439 return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11440 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
11441 return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11442 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
11443 return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11444 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
11445 return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11446 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
11447 return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11448 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
11449 return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11450 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
11451 return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11452 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
11453 return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11454 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
11455 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11456 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
11457 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11458 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-cb") == 0)
11459 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11460 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-bc") == 0)
11461 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11462 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
11463 return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11464 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
11465 return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11466 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
11467 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11468 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
11469 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11470 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-sve") == 0)
11471 return elfcore_write_aarch_sve (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11472 return NULL;
11473 }
11474
11475 static bfd_boolean
11476 elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset,
11477 size_t align)
11478 {
11479 char *p;
11480
11481 /* NB: CORE PT_NOTE segments may have p_align values of 0 or 1.
11482 gABI specifies that PT_NOTE alignment should be aligned to 4
11483 bytes for 32-bit objects and to 8 bytes for 64-bit objects. If
11484 align is less than 4, we use 4 byte alignment. */
11485 if (align < 4)
11486 align = 4;
11487 if (align != 4 && align != 8)
11488 return FALSE;
11489
11490 p = buf;
11491 while (p < buf + size)
11492 {
11493 Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
11494 Elf_Internal_Note in;
11495
11496 if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
11497 return FALSE;
11498
11499 in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
11500
11501 in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
11502 in.namedata = xnp->name;
11503 if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
11504 return FALSE;
11505
11506 in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
11507 in.descdata = p + ELF_NOTE_DESC_OFFSET (in.namesz, align);
11508 in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
11509 if (in.descsz != 0
11510 && (in.descdata >= buf + size
11511 || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
11512 return FALSE;
11513
11514 switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
11515 {
11516 default:
11517 return TRUE;
11518
11519 case bfd_core:
11520 {
11521 #define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
11522 struct
11523 {
11524 const char * string;
11525 size_t len;
11526 bfd_boolean (* func)(bfd *, Elf_Internal_Note *);
11527 }
11528 grokers[] =
11529 {
11530 GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note),
11531 GROKER_ELEMENT ("FreeBSD", elfcore_grok_freebsd_note),
11532 GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note),
11533 GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note),
11534 GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note),
11535 GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note)
11536 };
11537 #undef GROKER_ELEMENT
11538 int i;
11539
11540 for (i = ARRAY_SIZE (grokers); i--;)
11541 {
11542 if (in.namesz >= grokers[i].len
11543 && strncmp (in.namedata, grokers[i].string,
11544 grokers[i].len) == 0)
11545 {
11546 if (! grokers[i].func (abfd, & in))
11547 return FALSE;
11548 break;
11549 }
11550 }
11551 break;
11552 }
11553
11554 case bfd_object:
11555 if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
11556 {
11557 if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
11558 return FALSE;
11559 }
11560 else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
11561 && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
11562 {
11563 if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
11564 return FALSE;
11565 }
11566 break;
11567 }
11568
11569 p += ELF_NOTE_NEXT_OFFSET (in.namesz, in.descsz, align);
11570 }
11571
11572 return TRUE;
11573 }
11574
11575 static bfd_boolean
11576 elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size,
11577 size_t align)
11578 {
11579 char *buf;
11580
11581 if (size == 0 || (size + 1) == 0)
11582 return TRUE;
11583
11584 if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
11585 return FALSE;
11586
11587 buf = (char *) bfd_malloc (size + 1);
11588 if (buf == NULL)
11589 return FALSE;
11590
11591 /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
11592 0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow. */
11593 buf[size] = 0;
11594
11595 if (bfd_bread (buf, size, abfd) != size
11596 || !elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset, align))
11597 {
11598 free (buf);
11599 return FALSE;
11600 }
11601
11602 free (buf);
11603 return TRUE;
11604 }
11605 \f
11606 /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
11607
11608 /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
11609 copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
11610 occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
11611
11612 long
11613 bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
11614 {
11615 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11616 {
11617 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
11618 return -1;
11619 }
11620
11621 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
11622 }
11623
11624 /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
11625 will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
11626 defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
11627 buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
11628
11629 Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
11630 error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
11631
11632 int
11633 bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
11634 {
11635 int num_phdrs;
11636
11637 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11638 {
11639 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
11640 return -1;
11641 }
11642
11643 num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
11644 if (num_phdrs != 0)
11645 memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
11646 num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
11647
11648 return num_phdrs;
11649 }
11650
11651 enum elf_reloc_type_class
11652 _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11653 const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11654 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11655 {
11656 return reloc_class_normal;
11657 }
11658
11659 /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
11660 relocation against a local symbol. */
11661
11662 bfd_vma
11663 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
11664 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
11665 asection **psec,
11666 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
11667 {
11668 asection *sec = *psec;
11669 bfd_vma relocation;
11670
11671 relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
11672 + sec->output_offset
11673 + sym->st_value);
11674 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
11675 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
11676 && sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
11677 {
11678 rel->r_addend =
11679 _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
11680 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11681 sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
11682 if (sec != *psec)
11683 {
11684 /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
11685 marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
11686 SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
11687 other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
11688 some info around for --emit-relocs. */
11689 if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
11690 sec->kept_section = *psec;
11691 sec = *psec;
11692 }
11693 rel->r_addend -= relocation;
11694 rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
11695 }
11696 return relocation;
11697 }
11698
11699 bfd_vma
11700 _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
11701 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
11702 asection **psec,
11703 bfd_vma addend)
11704 {
11705 asection *sec = *psec;
11706
11707 if (sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
11708 return sym->st_value + addend;
11709
11710 return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
11711 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11712 sym->st_value + addend);
11713 }
11714
11715 /* Adjust an address within a section. Given OFFSET within SEC, return
11716 the new offset within the section, based upon changes made to the
11717 section. Returns -1 if the offset is now invalid.
11718 The offset (in abnd out) is in target sized bytes, however big a
11719 byte may be. */
11720
11721 bfd_vma
11722 _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
11723 struct bfd_link_info *info,
11724 asection *sec,
11725 bfd_vma offset)
11726 {
11727 switch (sec->sec_info_type)
11728 {
11729 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
11730 return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11731 offset);
11732 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
11733 return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
11734
11735 default:
11736 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
11737 {
11738 /* Reverse the offset. */
11739 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11740 bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
11741
11742 /* address_size and sec->size are in octets. Convert
11743 to bytes before subtracting the original offset. */
11744 offset = (sec->size - address_size) / bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd) - offset;
11745 }
11746 return offset;
11747 }
11748 }
11749 \f
11750 /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
11751 reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
11752 based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
11753 points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
11754 between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
11755 file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
11756
11757 The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
11758 remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
11759 should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
11760 be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
11761 the remote memory. */
11762
11763 bfd *
11764 bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
11765 (bfd *templ,
11766 bfd_vma ehdr_vma,
11767 bfd_size_type size,
11768 bfd_vma *loadbasep,
11769 int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type))
11770 {
11771 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
11772 (templ, ehdr_vma, size, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
11773 }
11774 \f
11775 long
11776 _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
11777 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11778 asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11779 long dynsymcount,
11780 asymbol **dynsyms,
11781 asymbol **ret)
11782 {
11783 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11784 asection *relplt;
11785 asymbol *s;
11786 const char *relplt_name;
11787 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
11788 arelent *p;
11789 long count, i, n;
11790 size_t size;
11791 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
11792 char *names;
11793 asection *plt;
11794
11795 *ret = NULL;
11796
11797 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
11798 return 0;
11799
11800 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
11801 return 0;
11802
11803 if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
11804 return 0;
11805
11806 relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
11807 if (relplt_name == NULL)
11808 relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
11809 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
11810 if (relplt == NULL)
11811 return 0;
11812
11813 hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
11814 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
11815 || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
11816 return 0;
11817
11818 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
11819 if (plt == NULL)
11820 return 0;
11821
11822 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
11823 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
11824 return -1;
11825
11826 count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
11827 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
11828 p = relplt->relocation;
11829 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
11830 {
11831 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
11832 if (p->addend != 0)
11833 {
11834 #ifdef BFD64
11835 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
11836 #else
11837 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
11838 #endif
11839 }
11840 }
11841
11842 s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
11843 if (s == NULL)
11844 return -1;
11845
11846 names = (char *) (s + count);
11847 p = relplt->relocation;
11848 n = 0;
11849 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
11850 {
11851 size_t len;
11852 bfd_vma addr;
11853
11854 addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
11855 if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
11856 continue;
11857
11858 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
11859 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
11860 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
11861 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
11862 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
11863 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
11864 s->section = plt;
11865 s->value = addr - plt->vma;
11866 s->name = names;
11867 s->udata.p = NULL;
11868 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
11869 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
11870 names += len;
11871 if (p->addend != 0)
11872 {
11873 char buf[30], *a;
11874
11875 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
11876 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
11877 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
11878 for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
11879 ;
11880 len = strlen (a);
11881 memcpy (names, a, len);
11882 names += len;
11883 }
11884 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
11885 names += sizeof ("@plt");
11886 ++s, ++n;
11887 }
11888
11889 return n;
11890 }
11891
11892 /* It is only used by x86-64 so far.
11893 ??? This repeats *COM* id of zero. sec->id is supposed to be unique,
11894 but current usage would allow all of _bfd_std_section to be zero. */
11895 static const asymbol lcomm_sym
11896 = GLOBAL_SYM_INIT ("LARGE_COMMON", &_bfd_elf_large_com_section);
11897 asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
11898 = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section, &lcomm_sym,
11899 "LARGE_COMMON", 0, SEC_IS_COMMON);
11900
11901 void
11902 _bfd_elf_post_process_headers (bfd * abfd,
11903 struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11904 {
11905 Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
11906
11907 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
11908
11909 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
11910
11911 /* To make things simpler for the loader on Linux systems we set the
11912 osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains symbols of
11913 the STT_GNU_IFUNC type or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
11914 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE
11915 && elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_symbols)
11916 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
11917 }
11918
11919
11920 /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
11921 This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
11922 most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
11923
11924 bfd_boolean
11925 _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
11926 {
11927 return (type == STT_FUNC
11928 || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
11929 }
11930
11931 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
11932 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
11933 otherwise return zero. */
11934
11935 bfd_size_type
11936 _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
11937 bfd_vma *code_off)
11938 {
11939 bfd_size_type size;
11940
11941 if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
11942 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0
11943 || sym->section != sec)
11944 return 0;
11945
11946 *code_off = sym->value;
11947 size = 0;
11948 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
11949 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
11950 if (size == 0)
11951 size = 1;
11952 return size;
11953 }
This page took 0.375299 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.